TP Link Network Router WiFi Pocket Router AP TV Adapter repeater User Manual

TL-WR710N  
WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Rev: 2.0.0  
1910010956  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FCC STATEMENT  
This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B digital device,  
pursuant to part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection  
against harmful interference in a residential installation. This equipment generates, uses and can  
radiate radio frequency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with the instructions,  
may cause harmful interference to radio communications. However, there is no guarantee that  
interference will not occur in a particular installation. If this equipment does cause harmful  
interference to radio or television reception, which can be determined by turning the equipment off  
and on, the user is encouraged to try to correct the interference by one or more of the following  
measures:  
Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna.  
Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver.  
Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit different from that to which the receiver  
is connected.  
Consult the dealer or an experienced radio/ TV technician for help.  
This device complies with part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two  
conditions:  
1This device may not cause harmful interference.  
2This device must accept any interference received, including interference that may  
cause undesired operation.  
Any changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance  
could void the user’s authority to operate the equipment.  
Note: The manufacturer is not responsible for any radio or TV interference caused by  
unauthorized modifications to this equipment. Such modifications could void the user’s authority  
to operate the equipment.  
FCC RF Radiation Exposure Statement:  
This equipment complies with FCC RF radiation exposure limits set forth for an uncontrolled  
environment. This device and its antenna must not be co-located or operating in conjunction with  
any other antenna or transmitter.  
To comply with FCC RF exposure compliance requirements, this grant is applicable to only  
Mobile Configurations. The antennas used for this transmitter must be installed to provide a  
separation distance of at least 20 cm from all persons and must not be co-located or operating in  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
conjunction with any other antenna or transmitter.”  
CE Mark Warning  
This is a class B product. In a domestic environment, this product may cause radio interference, in  
which case the user may be required to take adequate measures.  
Canadian Compliance Statement  
This device complies with Industry Canada license-exempt RSS standard(s). Operation is subject  
to the following two conditions:  
(1) This device may not cause interference, and  
(2)This device must accept any interference, including interference that may cause undesired  
operation of the device.  
Cet appareil est conforme aux norms CNR exemptes de licence d’Industrie Canada. Le  
fonctionnement est soumis aux deux conditions suivantes:  
(1) cet appareil ne doit pas provoquer d’interférences et  
(2) cet appareil doit accepter toute interférence, y compris celles susceptibles de provoquer un  
fonctionnement non souhaité de l’appareil.  
Industry Canada Statement  
Complies with the Canadian ICES-003 Class B specifications.  
Cet appareil numérique de la classe B est conforme à la norme NMB-003 du Canada.  
This device complies with RSS 210 of Industry Canada. This Class B device meets all the  
requirements of the Canadian interference-causing equipment regulations.  
Cet appareil numérique de la Classe B respecte toutes les exigences du Règlement sur le  
matériel brouilleur du Canada.  
Korea Warning Statements  
당해 무선설비는 운용중 전파혼신 가능성이 있음.  
NCC Notice & BSMI Notice  
注意!  
依據 低功率電波輻射性電機管理辦法  
第十二條 經型式認證合格之低功率射頻電機,非經許可,公司、商號或使用者均不得擅自變更頻  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
率、加大功率或變更原設計之特性或功能。  
第十四條 低功率射頻電機之使用不得影響飛航安全及干擾合法通行;經發現有干擾現象時,應立  
即停用,並改善至無干擾時方得繼續使用。前項合法通信,指依電信規定作業之無線電信。低功率  
射頻電機需忍受合法通信或工業、科學以及醫療用電波輻射性電機設備之干擾。  
減少電磁波影響,請妥適使用。  
安全諮詢及注意事項  
●請使用原裝電源供應器或只能按照本產品注明的電源類型使用本產品。  
●清潔本產品之前請先拔掉電源線。請勿使用液體、噴霧清潔劑或濕布進行清潔。  
●注意防潮,請勿將水或其他液體潑灑到本產品上。   
●插槽與開口供通風使用,以確保本產品的操作可靠並防止過熱,請勿堵塞或覆蓋開口。  
●請勿將本產品置放於靠近熱源的地方。除非有正常的通風,否則不可放在密閉位置中。  
●請不要私自打開機殼,不要嘗試自行維修本產品,請由授權的專業人士進行此項工作。  
Продукт сертифіковано згідно с правилами системи УкрСЕПРО на відповідність вимогам  
нормативних документів та вимогам, що передбачені чинними законодавчими актами  
України.  
Safety Information  
z
When product has power button, the power button is one of the way to shut off the product;  
when there is no power button, the only way to completely shut off power is to disconnect the  
product or the power adapter from the power source.  
z
z
Don’t disassemble the product, or make repairs yourself. You run the risk of electric shock  
and voiding the limited warranty. If you need service, please contact us.  
Avoid water and wet locations.  
This product can be used in the following countries:  
AT  
BG  
FI  
BY  
FR  
CA  
GB  
CZ  
DE  
HU  
DK  
IE  
EE  
IT  
ES  
GR  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
LT  
LV  
MT  
SK  
NL  
TR  
NO  
UA  
PL  
PT  
RO  
RU  
SE  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TP-LINK TECHNOLOGIES CO., LTD  
DECLARATION OF CONFORMITY  
For the following equipment:  
Product Description: WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Model No.: TL-WR710N  
Trademark: TP-LINK  
We declare under our own responsibility that the above products satisfy all the technical  
regulations applicable to the product within the scope of Council Directives:  
Directives 1999/5/EC, Directives 2004/108/EC, Directives 2006/95/EC, Directives 1999/519/EC,  
Directives 2011/65/EU  
The above product is in conformity with the following standards or other normative documents  
ETSI EN 300 328 V1.7.1: 2006  
ETSI EN 301 489-1 V1.9.2:2011& ETSI EN 301 489-17 V2.2.1:2012  
EN 55022:2010  
EN 55024:2010  
EN 61000-3-2:2006+A1:2009+A2:2009  
EN 61000-3-3:2008  
EN 60950-1:2006+A112009+A1:2010+A12:2011  
EN 62311:2008  
The product carries the CE Mark:  
Person responsible for making this declaration:  
Yang Hongliang  
Product Manager of International Business  
Date of issue: 2014  
TP-LINK TECHNOLOGIES CO., LTD.  
Building 24 (floors 1, 3, 4, 5), and 28 (floors 1-4) Central Science and Technology Park,  
Shennan Rd, Nanshan, Shenzhen, China  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CONTENTS  
- I -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
- II -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
- III -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
- IV -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
- V -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
- VI -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
- VII -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
- VIII -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Package Contents  
The following items should be found in your package:  
¾
¾
¾
¾
One TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Quick Installation Guide  
One RJ-45 Ethernet Cable  
One Resource CD for TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater, including:  
User Guide  
Other Helpful Information  
Note:  
)
Make sure that the package contains the above items. If any of the listed items is damaged or  
missing, please contact with your distributor. The provided power plug may differ from the picture due  
to different regional power specifications. Here we take the EU version as an example.  
- 1 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Chapter 1. Introduction  
1.1 Overview of the Router  
Small enough to fit in the average pocket, the TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV  
Adapter/Repeater is uniquely suited to provide robust wireless networking to travelers, students,  
or anyone else for work or play.  
Incredible Speed  
TL-WR710N supports the newest 802.11n standards, and provides backward compatibility with  
older 802.11b/g standards as well. The up-to-150Mbps wireless speed makes it ideal for handling  
multiple data streams at the same time, which ensures your network stable and smooth.  
Multiple Operation Modes  
The TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater supports five operation modes.  
Wireless Router mode creates an instant private wireless network and share Internet to multiple Wi-Fi  
devices, which is suitable for most hotel and home network. Access Point mode creates a wireless  
network for Wi-Fi devices. The wireless devices are exposed to the wired network. Repeater mode  
extends your home wireless range by copying the same wireless name and password. Client mode  
works as a wireless adapter for any Ethernet-enabled devices, such as Smart TV, Game Console and  
PC. WISP Client Router mode accesses the Internet wirelessly in areas with no wired ISP  
infrastructure  
Reliable Security Protections  
With multiple protection measures, including SSID broadcast control and wireless LAN  
64/128/152-bit WEP encryption, WiFi protected Access (WPA2-PSK, WPA-PSK), as well as  
advanced Firewall protections, the TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
provides complete data privacy.  
Flexible Access Control  
The TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater supports Virtual Server and DMZ  
host for Port Triggering, and then the network administrators can manage and monitor the network in  
real time with the remote management function.  
Since the Router is compatible with virtually all the major operating systems, it is very easy to  
manage. Quick Setup Wizard is supported and detailed instructions are provided step by step in  
- 2 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
this user guide. Before installing the Router, please look through this guide to know all the  
Router’s functions.  
1.2 Conventions  
The Router or TL-WR710N mentioned in this guide stands for TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV  
Adapter/Repeater without any explanation.  
Parameters provided in the pictures are just references for setting up the product, which may  
differ from the actual situation.  
You can set the parameters according to your demand.  
1.3 Main Features  
¾
¾
¾
¾
¾
¾
Portable design, ideal for travel and home use  
Built-in power supply design without external power adapter  
Support Wireless Router, Access Point, Repeater, Client, WISP Client Router modes  
USB port supports charging for smart phone and tablet  
USB port supports storage sharing, media server function  
Pre-encryption prevents unauthorized access from users outside of the network  
1.4 Panel Layout  
Figure 1-1 TL-WR710N sketch  
- 3 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
¾
LED  
Status  
Indication  
Solid Green The device is working properly.  
Condition 1: System is booting.  
Blinking  
Condition 2: The Ethernet Cable or USB Device is  
connecting to the product.  
Table 1-1 The LED Description  
¾
¾
USB: It is used to connect USB Flash or Hard Disk for ÿle sharing and Mobile devices for  
charging.  
ResetIt is used to reset the Router to its factory defaults. With the Router powered on, use  
a pin to press and hold the Reset button (about 5 seconds) until the SYS LED becomes  
quick-flash from slow-flash. And then release the button and wait the Router to reboot to its  
factory default settings.  
¾
¾
LAN/WAN: This LAN/WAN port works as LAN in AP/Repeater/Client/WISP Client Router  
mode and as WAN in Wireless Router mode. As LAN, it connects the Router to the local PC;  
as WAN, it enables you connect the DSL/cable Modem, or Ethernet.  
LAN: This LAN port works as LAN in Wireless Router/ AP/Repeater/Client/WISP Client  
Router mode. It connects the Router to the local PC.  
- 4 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Chapter 2. Connecting the Router  
2.1 System Requirements  
¾
¾
¾
¾
Each PC in the LAN needs a working Ethernet Adapter  
TCP/IP protocol must be installed on each PC  
Web browser, such as Microsoft Internet Explorer 5.0 or later, Mozilla Firefox, Apple Safari  
If the device is configured to Wireless Router/Access Point mode, you also need Broadband  
Internet Access Service (DSL/Cable/Ethernet)  
¾
One DSL/Cable Modem that has an RJ45 connector (which is not necessary if the Router is  
connected directly to the Ethernet.)  
2.2 Installation Environment Requirements  
¾
¾
Place the Router in a well-ventilated place far from any heater or heating vent  
Place the Router in a location where it can be connected to the various devices as well as to  
a power source  
¾
¾
¾
¾
Avoid direct irradiation of any strong light (such as sunlight)  
Keep at least 2 inches (5 cm) of clear space around the Router  
Operating Temperature: 0~40(32~104)  
Operating Humidity: 10%~90%RH, Non-condensing  
2.3 Connecting the Router  
Before installing the Router, please make sure your broadband service provided by your ISP is  
available. If there is any problem, please contact with your ISP. To connect the Router, please  
follow the steps below:  
1. Power off your PC, Cable/DSL Modem, and the Router.  
2. Locate an optimum location for the Router. The best place is usually at the center of your  
wireless network. The place must accord with the Installation Environment Requirements.  
3. Plug the power plug in the electrical wall socket. The Router will start to work automatically.  
After finishing the steps above, please choose the operation mode you need and carry out the  
corresponding steps. There are five operation modes supported by this router: Wireless Router,  
Access Point, Repeater, Client and WISP Client Router.  
- 5 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
2.3.1 Wireless Router Mode  
Create an instant private wireless network and share Internet to multiple Wi-Fi devices. This mode  
is suitable for hotel rooms and home networks. (Note: if the hotel’s Internet has an authentication  
process, you will need to authenticate only once and only on one device.)  
Figure 2-1 Hardware Installation of the TL-WR710N in Router Mode  
1. Connect the LAN/WAN port of TL-WR710N to the LAN Port on the DSL/Cable Modem.  
2. Connect the WAN port on the DSL/Cable Modem to the wired Internet.  
3. Plug the power plug of TL-WR710N in electrical wall socket.  
4. Power on the DSL/Cable Modem, PC(s) and notebook(s).  
2.3.2 Access Point Mode  
Create a wireless network from an Ethernet connection. This mode is suitable for dorm rooms or  
homes where there's already a wired router but you need a wireless hotspot. (Note: if the hotel’s  
Internet has an authentication process, you will need to authenticate it on EACH device.)  
Figure 2-2 Hardware Installation of the TL-WR710N in AP Mode  
- 6 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
1. Connect the LAN or LAN/WAN port of TL-WR710N to the wired network port with an Ethernet  
cable.  
2. Plug the power plug of TL-WR710N in electrical wall socket.  
3. Power on the PC(s) and notebook(s).  
2.3.3 Repeater Mode  
Repeat signal from an existing wireless network. This mode is suitable to extend wireless  
coverage, reaching devices that were previously too far from your primary router to maintain a  
stable wireless connection. The repeated signal will display the same network name and  
password as your existing wireless network.  
Figure 2-3 Hardware Installation of the TL-WR710N in Repeater Mode  
1. Plug the power plug of TL-WR710N in electrical wall socket.  
2. Power on the notebook(s).  
Note:  
)
It is recommended that you connect a PC/notebook to the LAN port of the Router with an Ethernet  
cable, and then login the Router from the PC/notebook to set the Router in Repeater mode.  
2.3.4 Client Mode  
In this mode, this device can be connected to another device via Ethernet cable and act as an  
adapter to grant your wired devices access to a wireless network, especially for a Smart TV,  
Media Player, or Game console only with an Ethernet port.  
- 7 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure 2-4 Hardware Installation of the TL-WR710N in Client Mode  
1. Connect the PC to the LAN or LAN/WAN port of TL-WR710N router with an Ethernet cable.  
2. Plug the power plug of TL-WR710N in electrical wall socket.  
3. Power on the PC(s).  
2.3.5 WISP Client Router Mode  
Use as a client router to receive Internet access from a Wireless Internet Service Provider (WISP),  
and share that access with local devices.  
Figure 2-5 Hardware Installation of the TL-WR710N in WISP Client Router Mode  
1. Plug the power plug of TL-WR710N in electrical wall socket.  
2. Power on the notebook(s).  
- 8 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Chapter 3. Quick Installation Guide  
This chapter will show you how to configure the basic functions of your TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket  
Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater using Quick Setup Wizard within minutes.  
3.1 TCP/IP Configuration  
The default IP address of the TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater is  
192.168.0.254. And the default Subnet Mask is 255.255.255.0. These values can be changed as  
you desire. In this guide, we use all the default values for description.  
Connect the local PC to the LAN port of the Router. And then you can configure the IP address for  
your PC as the following steps:  
1) Set up the TCP/IP Protocol in "Obtain an IP address automatically" mode on your PC. If  
you need instructions as to how to do this, please refer to Appendix B: "Configuring the PC”.  
2) Then the built-in DHCP server will assign IP address for the PC.  
Then connect to the Router through wireless connection following the steps below:  
1)  
Click the icon  
at the bottom of your desktop. Click refresh button, and then select the  
default SSID of the Router. Click Connect.  
- 9 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Enter the Security key. Click OK.  
2)  
3) If you can see Connected after the default SSID, you’ve successfully connected to the  
wireless network.  
Note:  
)
1. The default SSID and Password of your Router are on the label. Both are case-sensitive.  
2. The pre-encryption function is enabled by default and the default Network key/Security key  
is the Password on the label.  
Now, you can run the Ping command in the command prompt to verify the network connection  
between your PC and the Router. The following example is in Windows XP.  
Open a command prompt, and type ping 192.168.0.254, and then press Enter.  
¾
If the result displayed is similar to the Figure 3-1, it means the connection between your PC  
and the Router has been established well.  
- 10 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure 3-1 Success result of Ping command  
¾
If the result displayed is similar to the Figure 3-2, it means the connection between your PC  
and the Router has failed.  
Figure 3-2 Failure result of Ping command  
Please check the connection following these steps:  
1. Is the connection between your PC and the Router correct?  
Note:  
)
The LED of LAN/WAN ports which you link to on the Router should be lit.  
2. Is the TCP/IP configuration for your PC correct?  
Note:  
)
If the Router's IP address is 192.168.0.254, your PC's IP address must be within the range of  
192.168.0.1 ~ 192.168.0.253.  
- 11 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
3.2 Quick Installation Guide  
With a Web-based utility, it is easy to configure and manage the TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket  
Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater. The Web-based utility can be used on any Windows, Macintosh  
or UNIX OS with a Web browser, such as Microsoft Internet Explorer, Mozilla Firefox or Apple  
Safari.  
1. To access the configuration utility, open a web-browser and type in the default address  
http://tplinklogin.net in the address field of the browser.  
After a moment, a login window will appear, similar to the Figure 3-3. Enter admin for the  
User Name and Password, both in lower case letters. Then click the OK button or press the  
Enter key.  
Figure 3-3 Login Windows  
Note:  
)
If the above screen does not pop-up, it means that your Web-browser has been set to a proxy. Go  
to Tools menu>Internet Options>Connections>LAN Settings, in the screen that appears, cancel  
the Using Proxy checkbox, and click OK to finish it.  
2. After a successful login, you can click the Quick Setup menu to quickly configure your  
Router.  
Figure 3-4 Quick Setup  
- 12 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
3. Click Next, and then Working Mode page will appear, shown in Figure 3-5.  
Figure 3-5 Quick Setup - Working Mode  
Note:  
)
The Router supports five working modes for multi-user to access the Internet: Wireless Router,  
Access Point, Repeater, Client and WISP Client Router. In Wireless Router mode, the device  
enables multiple users to share the Internet connection via ADSL/Cable Modem. In Access Point  
mode, this device can be connected to a wired network and transform the wired access into  
wireless that multiple devices can share together. In Repeater mode, the device will relay data to  
an associated root AP. In Client mode, the device will act as a wireless station to enable wired  
host(s) to access AP. In WISP Client Router mode, the device enables multiple users to share  
Internet connection from WISP. You can configure your device quickly by the following steps in  
different modes.  
3.2.1 Wireless Router Mode  
When you choose Wireless Router on Working Mode page in Figure 3-5 , take the following  
steps:  
- 13 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
1. Click Next in Figure 3-5, and then WAN Connection Type page will appear as shown in  
Figure 3-6 Quick Setup - WAN Connection Type  
The Router provides Auto-Detect function and supports five popular ways Dynamic IP, Static IP,  
PPPoE/Russia PPPoE, L2TP/Russia L2TP and PPTP/Russia PPTP to connect to the Internet.  
It’s recommended that you make use of the Auto-Detect function. If you are sure of what kind of  
connection type your ISP provides, you can select the very type and click Next to go on  
configuring.  
Note:  
)
Auto-Detect function is not suitable for Static IP, L2TP/Russia L2TP and PPTP/Russia PPTP,  
you need to specify the connection type manually.  
2. If you select Auto-Detect, the Router will automatically detect the connection type your ISP  
provides. Make sure the cable is securely plugged into the WAN port before detection. The  
appropriate configuration page will be displayed when an active Internet service is successfully  
detected by the Router.  
1) If the connection type detected is Dynamic IP, the next screen will appear as shown in  
¾
In most cases you don’t need to clone the MAC address if you have rebooted the  
modem with the new router, please select No, I do NOT need to clone MAC  
address.  
¾
If you can’t get the Internet connection after Quick Setup, please run it again and  
select YES, I need to clone MAC address.  
Then click Next and Figure 3-12 will appear.  
- 14 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure 3-7 Quick Setup – MAC-Clone  
2) If the connection type detected is PPPoE/Russia PPPoE, the next screen will appear as  
Figure 3-8 Quick Setup – PPPoE  
¾
¾
User Name/Password - Enter the User Name and Password provided by your  
ISP. These fields are case sensitive. If you have difficulty with this process, please  
contact your ISP.  
Confirm Password - Re-enter the password provided by your ISP to ensure the  
Password you entered is correct. If the Password is different from the Confirm  
Password, the screen will appear as shown below. Click OK, and re-enter the  
Password and Confirm Password.  
- 15 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
If you select Static IP manually, the next screen will appear as shown in Figure 3-9. This type of  
connection uses a permanent, fixed (static) IP address that your ISP assigned. In this type, you  
should fill in the IP address, Subnet Mask, Default Gateway, and DNS IP address manually, which  
are specified by your ISP. Then click Next and proceed to Figure 3-12.  
Figure 3-9 Quick Setup - Static IP  
If you select L2TP/Russian L2TP and PPTP/Russian PPTP manually, the next screen will  
appear as shown in Figure 3-10 and Figure 3-11.  
Figure 3-10 Quick Setup - L2TP/Russian L2TP  
Figure 3-11 Quick Setup - PPTP/Russian PPTP  
¾
User Name/Password - Enter the User Name and Password provided by your ISP.  
- 16 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
These fields are case sensitive. If you have difficulty with this process, please contact  
your ISP.  
¾
¾
Dynamic IP/Static IP - Select Static IP if IP address, subnet mask, gateway and DNS  
server address have been provided by your ISP. Otherwise, please select Dynamic IP.  
Server IP Address/Name - Enter server IP address or domain name provided by your  
ISP.  
3. Then, the Wireless page will appear as shown in Figure 3-12. Set the wireless parameters. It  
is recommended that you rename an SSID, choose a Security Type and enter a Password.  
Then click Next.  
Figure 3-12 Quick Setup - Wireless  
¾
¾
Wireless Radio - Enable or disable the wireless radio choosing from the pull-down list.  
Wireless Network Name - Enter a string of up to 32 characters. The same name of  
SSID (Service Set Identification) must be assigned to all wireless devices in your  
network. The default SSID is set to be TP-LINK_XXXXXX (XXXXXX indicates the last  
unique six numbers of each Router’s MAC address). But it is recommended strongly  
that you change your networks name (SSID) to a different value. This value is  
case-sensitive. For example, TEST is NOT the same as test.  
¾
Region - Select your region from the pull-down list. This field specifies the region where  
the wireless function of the Router can be used. It may be illegal to use the wireless  
function of the Router in a region other than one of those specified in this field. If your  
- 17 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
country or region is not listed, please contact your local government agency for  
assistance.  
¾
¾
Disable Security - The wireless security function can be enabled or disabled. If  
disabled, the wireless stations will be able to connect the Router without encryption. It is  
recommended strongly that you choose one of following options to enable security.  
WPA-PSK/WPA2-PSK - Select WPA based on pre-shared passphrase.  
z
PSK Password - You can enter ASCII or Hexadecimal characters.  
For ASCII, the key can be made up of any numbers 0 to 9 and any letters A to Z, the  
length should be between 8 and 63 characters.  
For Hexadecimal, the key can be made up of any numbers 0 to 9 and letters A to F,  
the length should be between 8 and 64 characters.  
Please also note the key is case sensitive, this means that upper and lower case  
keys will affect the outcome. It would also be a good idea to write down the key and  
all related wireless security settings.  
¾
¾
No Change - If you chose this option, wireless security configuration will not change!  
More Advanced Wireless Settings – Select to configure more wireless parameters.  
Figure 3-13 Quick Setup - More Advanced Wireless Settings  
¾
¾
Mode - This field determines the wireless mode which the Router works on.  
Channel Width - Select any channel width from the drop-down list. The default setting  
is automatic, which can adjust the channel width for your clients automatically.  
¾
Channel - This field determines which operating frequency will be used. The default  
channel is set to Auto, so the AP will choose the best channel automatically. It is not  
necessary to change the wireless channel unless you notice interference problems with  
another nearby access point.  
These settings are only for basic wireless parameters. For advanced settings, please refer to  
- 18 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
4. The Finish page is shown as Figure 3-14. Click the Reboot button to make your wireless  
configuration take effect and finish the Quick Setup.  
Figure 3-14 Quick Setup – Finish  
3.2.2 Access Point Mode  
When you choose Access Point on Working Mode page in Figure 3-5 , take the following steps:  
1. Click Next in Figure 3-5, and then Wireless page will appear as shown in Figure 3-15.  
Figure 3-15 Quick Setup - Wireless  
¾
Wireless Network Name - Enter a string of up to 32 characters. The same name of  
SSID (Service Set Identification) must be assigned to all wireless devices in your  
network. The default SSID is set to be TP-LINK_XXXXXX (XXXXXX indicates the last  
unique six numbers of each Router’s MAC address). But it is recommended strongly  
that you change your networks name (SSID) to a different value. This value is  
case-sensitive. For example, TEST is NOT the same as test.  
¾
Region - Select your region from the pull-down list. This field specifies the region where  
the wireless function of the Router can be used. It may be illegal to use the wireless  
- 19 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
function of the Router in a region other than one of those specified in this field. If your  
country or region is not listed, please contact your local government agency for  
assistance.  
¾
¾
Channel - This field determines which operating frequency will be used. The default  
channel is set to Auto. It is not necessary to change the wireless channel unless you  
notice interference problems with another nearby access point.  
Mode - Select the desired mode. The default setting is 11bgn mixed.  
11bg mixed - Select if you are using both 802.11b and 802.11g wireless clients.  
11bgn mixed - Select if you are using a mix of 802.11b, 11g, and 11n wireless clients.  
When 11bg mixed mode is selected, only 11bg mixed wireless stations can connect to the  
Router. It is strongly recommended that you set the Mode to 11bgn mixed, and all of  
802.11b/g/n wireless stations can connect to the Router.  
Note:  
)
If 11bg mixed mode is selected in the Mode field, the Channel Width selecting field will turn  
grey and the value will become 20M, which is unable to be changed.  
¾
¾
Channel Width - Select any channel width from the pull-down list. The default setting is  
automatic, which can automatically adjust the channel width for your clients.  
Wireless Security Mode - This option should be chosen according to the security  
configuration of the AP you want to access. It is recommended that the security type is  
the same as your AP’s security type.  
¾
Wireless Password - Input the password of your broadcast SSID.  
2. Click the Next button. You will then see the Finish page.  
If you don’t make any change on the Wireless page, you will see the Finish page as shown  
in Figure 3-16. Click the Finish button to finish the Quick Setup.  
Figure 3-16 Quick Setup - Finish  
If there is something changed on the Wireless page, you will see the Finish page as shown  
in Figure 3-17. Click the Reboot button to make your wireless configuration take effect and  
finish the Quick Setup.  
- 20 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure 3-17 Quick Setup – Finish  
3.2.3 Repeater Mode  
When you choose Repeater Mode on Working Mode page in Figure 3-5 , take the following  
steps:  
1. Click Next, and then Wireless Repeater page will appear as shown in Figure 3-18.  
Figure 3-18 Quick Setup - Wireless  
¾
¾
¾
¾
Wireless Name of Root AP - The SSID of AP that you want to access.  
MAC Address of Root AP - The MAC address of AP that you want to access.  
Survey - Click this button, you can search the AP which runs in the environment.  
Region - Select your region from the pull-down list. This field specifies the region where  
the wireless function of the Router can be used. It may be illegal to use the wireless  
function of the Router in a region other than one of those specified in this field. If your  
country or region is not listed, please contact your local government agency for  
assistance.  
- 21 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
¾
WDS Mode - This field determines which WDS Mode will be used. It is not necessary to  
change the WDS Mode unless you notice network communication problems with root  
AP. If you select Auto, then Router will choose the appropriate WDS Mode  
automatically.  
¾
¾
Wireless Security Mode - This option should be chosen according to the security  
configuration of the AP you want to access. It is recommended that the security type is  
the same as your AP’s security type.  
Wireless Password - If the AP your router is going to connect need password, you  
need to fill the password in this blank.  
2. Click Survey button on the Wireless page as shown in Figure 3-18, and then AP List page will  
appear as shown in Figure 3-19. Find the SSID of the Access Point you want to access, and  
click Connect in the corresponding row. For example, the third item is selected. The target  
network’s SSID will be automatically filled into the corresponding box which is shown as the  
Figure 3-19 AP List  
)
Note:  
If you know the SSID of the desired AP, you can also input it into the field "SSID" manually.  
3. Click the Next button in Figure 3-18. You will then see the Finish page.  
Because something has changed on the Wireless Repeater page, you will see the Finish  
page as shown in Figure 3-20. Click the Reboot button to make your wireless configuration  
take effect and finish the Quick Setup.  
- 22 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure 3-20 Quick Setup - Finish  
3.2.4 Client Mode  
When you choose Client on Working Mode page in Figure 3-5 , take the following steps:  
1. Click Next in Figure 3-5, and then Wireless Client page will appear as shown in Figure 3-21.  
Figure 3-21 Quick Setup - Wireless  
¾
¾
Wireless Name of Root AP - Enter the SSID that you want to access.  
MAC Address of Root AP - Enter the MAC address of AP that you want to access.  
Survey - Click this button, you can survey the AP which runs in the environment.  
¾
¾
Region - Select your region from the pull-down list. This field specifies the region where  
the wireless function of the Router can be used. It may be illegal to use the wireless  
function of the Router in a region other than one of those specified in this field. If your  
country or region is not listed, please contact your local government agency for  
assistance.  
- 23 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
¾
¾
¾
WDS Mode - This field determines which WDS Mode will be used. It is not necessary to  
change the WDS Mode unless you notice network communication problems with root AP.  
If you select Auto, then Router will choose the appropriate WDS Mode automatically.  
Wireless Security Mode - This option should be chosen according to the security  
configuration of the AP you want to access. It is recommended that the security type is  
the same as your AP’s security type.  
Wireless Password - If the AP your router is going to connect need password, you need  
to fill the password in this blank.  
2. Click Survey button on the Wireless page as shown in Figure 3-21, and then AP List page will  
appear as shown in Figure 3-22. Find the SSID of the Access Point you want to access, and  
click Connect in the corresponding row. For example, the third item is selected. The target  
network’s SSID will be automatically filled into the corresponding box which is shown as the  
Figure 3-22 AP List  
3. Click the Next button in Figure 3-23. You will then see the Finish page. Click the Reboot  
button to make your wireless configuration take effect and finish the Quick Setup.  
Figure 3-23 Quick Setup - Finish  
- 24 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
3.2.5 WISP Client Router Mode  
When you choose WISP Client Router on Working Mode page in Figure 3-5 , take the following  
steps:  
1. Click Next, and then WAN Connection Type page will appear as shown in Figure 3-24.  
Figure 3-24 Quick Setup – WAN Connection Type  
The Router supports three popular ways Dynamic IP, Static IP and PPPoE to connect to the  
Internet. To make sure the connection type your ISP provides, please refer to the ISP. Make sure  
the cable is securely plugged into the WAN port before detection.  
¾
Dynamic IP - Your ISP uses a DHCP service to assign your Router an IP address for  
connecting to the Internet. When the Router connects to a DHCP server, or the ISP  
supplies you with DHCP connection, please choose this type. If you choose this type of  
connection, no configuration should be set and you can go on with the wireless  
configuration in Figure 3-27.  
¾
Static IP - This type of connection uses a permanent, fixed (static) IP address that your  
ISP assigned. In this type, you should fill in the IP address, Subnet Mask, Default  
Gateway, and DNS IP address manually, which are specified by your ISP. Then click  
Next and proceed to Figure 3-27.  
Figure 3-25 Quick Setup - Static IP  
- 25 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
¾
PPPoE - For this connection, you will need your account name and password from your  
ISP.  
If you have applied ADSL to realize Dial-up service, you should choose this type. Under  
this condition, you should fill in both the User Name and Password that the ISP supplied.  
Please note that these fields are case-sensitive.  
Figure 3-26 Quick Setup - PPPoE  
2. You can configure the basic settings for the wireless network on this page.  
Figure 3-27 Quick Setup - Static IP  
¾
SSID - The SSID of the AP your router is going to connect to as a client. You can also use  
the search function to select the SSID to join.  
- 26 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
¾
BSSID - The BSSID of the AP your router is going to connect to as a client. You can also  
use the search function to select the BSSID to join.  
¾
¾
Survey - Click this button, you can survey the AP which runs in the current channel.  
Key type - This option should be chosen according to the AP's security configuration. It  
is recommended that the security type is the same as your AP's security type.  
¾
¾
¾
¾
WEP Index - This option should be chosen if the key type is WEP (ASCII) or WEP (HEX).  
It indicates the index of the WEP key.  
Auth type - This option should be chosen if the key type is WEP (ASCII) or WEP (HEX).It  
indicates the authorization type of the Root AP.  
Password - If the AP your router is going to connect needs password, you need to fill the  
password in this blank.  
Local SSID - Enter a value of up to 32 characters. The same Name (SSID) must be  
assigned to all wireless devices in your network.  
¾
¾
Wireless Security Mode - You can configure the security settings of your wireless  
network.  
Wireless Password - Input the password of your Local SSID.  
3. Click Survey button on the Wireless page as shown in Figure 3-24, and then AP List page will  
appear as shown in Figure 3-28. Find the SSID of the Access Point you want to access, and  
click Connect in the corresponding row. For example, the third item is selected. The target  
network’s SSID will be automatically filled into the corresponding box which is shown as the  
Figure 3-24. Then click Next.  
Figure 3-28 AP List  
- 27 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
4. The Finish page is shown as Figure 3-29. Click the Reboot button to make your wireless  
configuration take effect and finish the Quick Setup.  
Figure 3-29 Quick Setup – Finish  
Note:  
)
The operating distance or range of your wireless connection varies significantly based on the  
physical placement of the Router. For best results, place your Router.  
z
z
z
Near the center of the area in which your wireless stations will operate.  
In an elevated location such as a high shelf.  
Away from the potential sources of interference, such as PCs, microwaves, and cordless  
phones.  
z
Away from large metal surfaces.  
Failure to follow these guidelines can result in significant performance degradation or inability to  
wirelessly connect to the Router.  
- 28 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Chapter 4. Configuration for Wireless Router Mode  
This chapter will show each Web page's key functions and the configuration way for Wireless  
Router Mode of TL-WR710N.  
4.1 Login  
After your successful login, you can configure and manage the device. There are main menus on  
the left of the web-based utility. Submenus will be available after you click one of the main menus.  
On the right, there are the corresponding explanations and instructions.  
Figure 4-1  
The detailed explanations for each Web page’s key function are listed below.  
4.2 Status  
The Status page provides the current status information about the Router on Wireless Router  
Mode. All information is read-only.  
- 29 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure 4-2  
¾
¾
¾
Firmware Version - The version information of the Router’s firmware.  
Hardware Version - The version information of the Router’s hardware.  
LAN - This field displays the current settings or information for the LAN, you can configure  
them in the Network > LAN page.  
MAC Address - The physical address of the Router, as seen from the LAN.  
IP Address - The LAN IP address of the Router.  
- 30 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Subnet Mask - The subnet mask associated with LAN IP address.  
¾
Wireless - This field displays basic information or status for wireless function, you can  
configure them in the Wireless > Wireless Settings page.  
Working Mode - The current wireless working mode in use.  
Wireless Radio - Indicates whether the wireless radio feature of the AP is enabled or  
disabled.  
Name (SSID) - The SSID of the AP.  
Mode - The current wireless mode which the Router works on.  
Channel Width - The current wireless channel width in use.  
Channel - The current wireless channel in use.  
MAC Address - The physical address of the Router, as seen from the WLAN.  
WDS Status - The status of WDS connection.  
¾
WAN - This field displays the current settings or information for the WAN, you can configure  
them in the Network > WAN page.  
MAC Address - The physical address of the WAN port, as seen from the Internet.  
IP Address - The current WAN (Internet) IP Address. This field will be blank or 0.0.0.0 if the  
IP Address is assigned dynamically and there is no connection to the Internet.  
Subnet Mask - The subnet mask associated with the WAN IP Address.  
Default Gateway - The Gateway currently used by the Router is shown here. When you  
use Dynamic IP as the connection Internet type, the Renew button will be displayed here.  
Click the Renew Button to obtain new IP parameters dynamically from the ISP. And if you  
have got an IP address, Release button will be displayed here. Click the Release button to  
release the IP address the Router has obtained from the ISP.  
¾
¾
DNS Server - The DNS (Domain Name System) server IP addresses currently used by the  
Router.  
Traffic Statistics - The Router’s traffic statistics.  
Received (Bytes) - Traffic that counted in bytes has been received out from the WAN port.  
Received (Packets) - Traffic that counted in packets has been received out from the WAN  
port.  
Sent (Bytes) - Traffic that counted in bytes has been sent out from the WAN port.  
Sent (Packets) - Traffic that counted in packets has been sent out from the WAN port.  
System Up Time - The length of the time since the Router was last powered on or reset.  
¾
Click the Refresh button to get the latest status and settings of the Router.  
- 31 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
4.3 Quick Setup  
4.4 WPS  
WPS (Wi-Fi Protected Setup) can help you to quickly and securely connect to a network. This  
section will guide you to add a new wireless device to an existing network quickly by function. The  
WPS function is only available when the Operation Mode is set to Access Point. Select menu  
WPS”, you will see the next screen shown in Figure 4-3.  
Figure 4-3 WPS  
¾
¾
WPS Status - To enable or disable the WPS function here.  
Current PIN - The current value of the device's PIN is displayed here. The default PIN of the  
device can be found in the label or User Guide.  
¾
¾
Restore PIN - Restore the PIN of the device to its default.  
Gen New PIN - Click this button, and then you can get a new random value for the device's  
PIN. You can ensure the network security by generating a new PIN.  
¾
¾
Disable PIN of this Device - WPS external registrar of entering the device’s PIN can be  
disabled or enabled manually. If the device receives multiple failed attempts to authenticate  
an external Registrar, this function will be disabled automatically.  
Add Device - You can add a new device to the existing network manually by clicking this  
button.  
To add a new device:  
If the wireless adapter supports Wi-Fi Protected Setup (WPS), you can establish a wireless  
connection between wireless adapter and device using either Push Button Configuration (PBC)  
method or PIN method.  
- 32 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Note:  
)
To build a successful connection by WPS, you should also do the corresponding configuration of  
the new device for WPS function meanwhile.  
For the configuration of the new device, here takes the Wireless Adapter of our company for  
example.  
I. By PBC  
If the wireless adapter supports Wi-Fi Protected Setup and the Push Button Configuration (PBC)  
method, you can add it to the network by PBC with the following two methods.  
Method One:  
Step 1: Keep the WPS Status as Enabled and click the Add Device button in Figure 4-3, then  
the following screen will appear.  
Figure 4-4 Add A New Device  
Step 2: Choose “Press the button of the new device in two minutes” and click Connect.  
Step 3: For the configuration of the wireless adapter, please choose “Push the button on my  
access point or wireless router” in the configuration utility of the WPS as below, and  
click Connect.  
The WPS Configuration Screen of Wireless Adapter  
- 33 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Step 4: Wait for a while until the next screen appears. Click OK to complete the WPS  
configuration.  
The WPS Configuration Screen of Wireless Adapter  
Method Two: Enter the PIN into my AP  
Step 1: For the configuration of the wireless adapter, please choose “Enter the PIN of this  
device into my access point or wireless router” in the configuration utility of the WPS  
as below, and click Connect.  
The WPS Configuration Screen of Wireless Adapter  
Note:  
)
In this example, the default PIN code of this adapter is 16952898 as the above figure shown.  
Step 2: Keep the WPS Status as Enabled and click the Add Device button in Figure 4-3.  
Step 3: Choose “Enter the new device's PIN” and enter the PIN code take 16952898 for  
exampleof the wireless adapter in the field after PIN as shown in the figure below.  
Then click Connect.  
- 34 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure 4-5 Add A New Device  
Method Three: Enter the PIN from my AP  
Step 1: Get the Current PIN code of the AP in Figure 4-3 (each AP has its unique PIN code. Here  
takes the PIN code 12345670 of this AP for example).  
Step 2: For the configuration of the wireless adapter, please choose “Enter the PIN of my  
access point or wireless router” in the configuration utility of the WPS as below, and  
enter the PIN code of the AP into the field after “Access Point PIN”. Then click Connect.  
The WPS Configuration Screen of Wireless Adapter  
Note:  
)
The default PIN code of the AP can be found in its label or the WPS configuration screen as  
You will see the following screen when the new device has successfully connected to the network.  
- 35 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure 4-6  
Note:  
)
1) The WPS LED on the AP will light green for five minutes if the device has been successfully  
added to the network.  
2) The WPS function cannot be configured if the Wireless function of the AP is disabled. Please  
make sure the Wireless function is enabled before configuring the WPS.  
4.5 Working Mode  
The Router supports five operation mode types: Wireless Router, Access Point, Repeater,  
Client and Wireless Client Router. Please select one you want. Click Save to save your choice,  
which is shown as Figure 4-7.  
Figure 4-7 Wireless Working Mode Settings  
¾
Wireless Router - The wireless Router Mode. In this mode, the device enables multi-user to  
share Internet via DSL/Cable Modem. The only wired port works as WAN.  
¾
¾
¾
Access Point - The wireless access point mode.  
Repeater - The wireless Repeater Mode. It could extend the range of wireless network.  
Client - The Client Mode. The computer connected by Ethernet could get access to an AP by  
Client mode.  
¾
WISP Client Router - In this mode, the device enables multiple users to share Internet  
connection from WISP.  
- 36 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
4.6 Network  
Figure 4-8 the Network menu  
There are three submenus under the Network menu (shown in Figure 4-8): WAN, MAC Clone  
and LAN. Click any of them, and you will be able to configure the corresponding function.  
4.6.1 WAN  
Choose menu “Network WAN”, and then you can configure the IP parameters of the WAN on  
the screen below.  
1. If your ISP provides the DHCP service, please choose Dynamic IP type, and the Router will  
automatically get IP parameters from your ISP. You can see the page as follow (Figure 4-9):  
Figure 4-9 WAN – Dynamic IP  
This page displays the WAN IP parameters assigned dynamically by your ISP, including IP  
address, Subnet Mask, Default Gateway, etc. Click the Renew button to renew the IP  
parameters from your ISP. Click the Release button to release the IP parameters.  
- 37 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
¾
MTU Size - The normal MTU (Maximum Transmission Unit) value for most Ethernet  
networks is 1500 Bytes. It is not recommended that you change the default MTU Size  
unless required by your ISP.  
¾
Use These DNS Servers - If your ISP gives you one or two DNS addresses, select Use  
These DNS Servers and enter the primary and secondary addresses into the correct  
fields. Otherwise, the DNS servers will be assigned dynamically from your ISP.  
Note:  
)
If you find error when you go to a website after entering the DNS addresses, it is likely that  
your DNS servers are set up improperly. You should contact your ISP to get DNS server  
addresses.  
¾
¾
Host Name - This option specifies the Host Name of the Router.  
Get IP with Unicast DHCP - A few ISPs' DHCP servers do not support the broadcast  
applications. If you cannot get the IP Address normally, you can choose this option. (It is  
rarely required.)  
Click the Save button to save your settings.  
2. If your ISP provides a static or fixed IP Address, Subnet Mask, Default Gateway and DNS  
setting, select Static IP. The Static IP settings page will appear as shown in Figure 4-10.  
Figure 4-10 WAN - Static IP  
¾
¾
IP Address - Enter the IP address in dotted-decimal notation provided by your ISP.  
Subnet Mask - Enter the subnet Mask in dotted-decimal notation provided by your ISP,  
usually is 255.255.255.0.  
¾
Default Gateway - Enter the gateway IP address in dotted-decimal notation provided by  
your ISP.  
- 38 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
¾
¾
MTU Size - The normal MTU (Maximum Transmission Unit) value for most Ethernet  
networks is 1500 Bytes. It is not recommended that you change the default MTU Size  
unless required by your ISP.  
Primary/Secondary DNS - (Optional) Enter one or two DNS addresses in  
dotted-decimal notation provided by your ISP.  
Click the Save button to save your settings.  
3. If your ISP provides a PPPoE connection, select PPPoE/Russia PPPoE option. Then you  
should enter the following parameters (Figure 4-11):  
Figure 4-11 WAN – PPPoE/Russia PPPoE  
¾
¾
¾
User Name/Password - Enter the User Name and Password provided by your ISP.  
These fields are case-sensitive.  
Confirm Password - Enter again the Password provided by your ISP to ensure the  
password you entered is correct.  
Secondary Connection - It’s available only for PPPoE Connection. If your ISP provides  
an extra Connection type such as Dynamic/Static IP to connect to a local area network,  
then you can check the radio button of Dynamic/Static IP to activate this secondary  
connection.  
Disabled - The Secondary Connection is disabled by default, so there is PPPoE  
connection only. This is recommended.  
- 39 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Dynamic IP - You can check this radio button to use Dynamic IP as the secondary  
connection to connect to the local area network provided by ISP.  
Static IP - You can check this radio button to use Static IP as the secondary  
connection to connect to the local area network provided by ISP.  
¾
Connect on Demand - In this mode, the Internet connection can be terminated  
automatically after a specified inactivity period (Max Idle Time) and be re-established  
when you attempt to access the Internet again. If you want your Internet connection  
keeps active all the time, please enter “0” in the Max Idle Time field. Otherwise, enter  
the number of minutes you want to have elapsed before your Internet access  
disconnects.  
¾
¾
Connect Automatically - The connection can be re-established automatically when it  
was down.  
Time-based Connecting - The connection will only be established in the period from the  
start time to the end time (both are in HH:MM format).  
Note:  
)
Only when you have configured the system time on “System Tools Time” page, will the  
Time-based Connecting function can take effect.  
¾
Connect Manually  
-
You can click the Connect/Disconnect button to  
connect/disconnect immediately. This mode also supports the Max Idle Time function as  
Connect on Demand mode. The Internet connection can be disconnected automatically  
after a specified inactivity period and re-established when you attempt to access the  
Internet again.  
Click the Connect button to connect immediately. Click the Disconnect button to disconnect  
immediately.  
Caution: Sometimes the connection cannot be terminated although you specify a time to  
Max Idle Time because some applications are visiting the Internet continually in the  
background.  
If you want to do some advanced configurations, please click the Advanced button, and the  
- 40 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure 4-12 PPPoE Advanced Settings  
¾
¾
MTU Size - The default MTU size is “1480” bytes, which is usually fine. It is not  
recommended that you change the default MTU Size unless required by your ISP.  
Service Name/AC Name - The service name and AC (Access Concentrator) name  
should not be configured unless you are sure it is necessary for your ISP. In most cases,  
leaving these fields blank will work.  
¾
¾
ISP Specified IP Address - If your ISP does not automatically assign IP addresses to  
the Router during login, please click “Use IP address specified by ISP” check box and  
enter the IP address provided by your ISP in dotted-decimal notation.  
Detect Online Interval - The Router will detect Access Concentrator online at every  
interval. The default value is “0”. You can input the value between “0” and “120”. The  
value “0” means no detect.  
¾
Primary DNS/Secondary DNS - If your ISP does not automatically assign DNS  
addresses to the Router during login, please click “Use the following DNS servers”  
check box and enter the IP address in dotted-decimal notation of your ISP’s primary  
DNS server. If a secondary DNS server address is available, enter it as well.  
Click the Save button to save your settings.  
4. If your ISP provides BigPond Cable connection, please select BigPond Cable option. Then  
you should enter the following parameters (Figure 4-13):  
- 41 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure 4-13 WAN – BigPond Cable  
¾
User Name/Password - Enter the User Name and Password provided by your ISP.  
These fields are case-sensitive.  
¾
¾
¾
Auth Server - Enter the authenticating server IP address or host name.  
Auth Domain - Type in the domain suffix server name based on your location,  
MTU Size - The default MTU size is “1480” bytes, which is usually fine. It is not  
recommended that you change the default MTU Size unless required by your ISP.  
¾
Connect on Demand - In this mode, the Internet connection can be terminated  
automatically after a specified inactivity period (Max Idle Time) and be re-established  
when you attempt to access the Internet again. If you want your Internet connection  
keeps active all the time, please enter “0” in the Max Idle Time field. Otherwise, enter  
the number of minutes you want to have elapsed before your Internet access  
disconnects.  
¾
¾
Connect Automatically - The connection can be re-established automatically when it  
was down.  
Connect Manually  
-
You can click the Connect/Disconnect button to  
connect/disconnect immediately. This mode also supports the Max Idle Time function as  
Connect on Demand mode. The Internet connection can be disconnected automatically  
- 42 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
after a specified inactivity period and re-established when you attempt to access the  
Internet again.  
Click the Connect button to connect immediately. Click the Disconnect button to disconnect  
immediately.  
Caution: Sometimes the connection cannot be terminated although you specify a time to  
Max Idle Time because some applications are visiting the Internet continually in the  
background.  
Click the Save button to save your settings.  
5. If your ISP provides L2TP connection, please select L2TP/Russia L2TP option. Then you  
should enter the following parameters (Figure 4-14):  
Figure 4-14 WAN – L2TP/Russia L2TP  
¾
¾
User Name/Password - Enter the User Name and Password provided by your ISP.  
These fields are case-sensitive.  
Dynamic IP/ Static IP - Choose either as you are given by your ISP. Click the Connect  
button to connect immediately. Click the Disconnect button to disconnect immediately.  
- 43 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
¾
Connect on Demand - You can configure the Router to disconnect from your Internet  
connection after a specified period of inactivity (Max Idle Time). If your Internet  
connection has been terminated due to inactivity, Connect on Demand enables the  
Router to automatically re-establish your connection as soon as you attempt to access  
the Internet again. If you wish to activate Connect on Demand, check the radio button.  
If you want your Internet connection to remain active at all times, enter 0 in the Max Idle  
Time field. Otherwise, enter the number of minutes you want to have elapsed before  
your Internet connection terminates.  
¾
¾
Connect Automatically - Connect automatically after the Router is disconnected. To  
use this option, check the radio button.  
Connect Manually - You can configure the Router to make it connect or disconnect  
manually. After a specified period of inactivity (Max Idle Time), the Router will  
disconnect from your Internet connection, and you will not be able to re-establish your  
connection automatically as soon as you attempt to access the Internet again. To use  
this option, check the radio button. If you want your Internet connection to remain active  
at all times, enter "0" in the Max Idle Time field. Otherwise, enter the number of minutes  
that you wish to have the Internet connecting last unless a new link is requested.  
Caution: Sometimes the connection cannot be disconnected although you specify a time to  
Max Idle Time, because some applications are visiting the Internet continually in the  
background.  
Click the Save button to save your settings.  
6. If your ISP provides PPTP connection, please select PPTP/Russia PPTP option. And you  
should enter the following parameters (Figure 4-15):  
- 44 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure 4-15 WAN – PPTP/Russia PPTP  
¾
¾
User Name/Password - Enter the User Name and Password provided by your ISP.  
These fields are case-sensitive.  
Dynamic IP/ Static IP - Choose either as you are given by your ISP and enter the ISP’s  
IP address or the domain name.  
If you choose static IP and enter the domain name, you should also enter the DNS  
assigned by your ISP. And click the Save button.  
Click the Connect button to connect immediately. Click the Disconnect button to  
disconnect immediately.  
¾
Connect on Demand - You can configure the Router to disconnect from your Internet  
connection after a specified period of inactivity (Max Idle Time). If your Internet  
connection has been terminated due to inactivity, Connect on Demand enables the  
Router to automatically re-establish your connection as soon as you attempt to access  
the Internet again. If you wish to activate Connect on Demand, check the radio button.  
If you want your Internet connection to remain active at all times, enter “0” in the Max  
- 45 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Idle Time field. Otherwise, enter the number of minutes you want to have elapsed before  
your Internet connection terminates.  
¾
¾
Connect Automatically - Connect automatically after the Router is disconnected. To  
use this option, check the radio button.  
Connect Manually - You can configure the Router to make it connect or disconnect  
manually. After a specified period of inactivity (Max Idle Time), the Router will  
disconnect from your Internet connection, and you will not be able to re-establish your  
connection automatically as soon as you attempt to access the Internet again. To use  
this option, click the radio button. If you want your Internet connection to remain active at  
all times, enter "0" in the Max Idle Time field. Otherwise, enter the number in minutes  
that you wish to have the Internet connecting last unless a new link is requested.  
Caution: Sometimes the connection cannot be disconnected although you specify a time to  
Max Idle Time because some applications are visiting the Internet continually in the  
background.  
Click the Save button to save your settings.  
4.6.2 MAC Clone  
Choose menu “Network MAC Clone”, and then you can configure the WAN MAC address  
on the screen below, as shown in Figure 4-16:  
Figure 4-16 MAC Address Clone  
Some ISPs require that you register the MAC Address of your adapter. Changes are rarely  
needed here.  
¾
WAN MAC Address - This field displays the current MAC address of the WAN port. If your  
ISP requires you to register the MAC address, please enter the correct MAC address into  
this field in XX-XX-XX-XX-XX-XX format (X is any hexadecimal digit).  
¾
Your PC's MAC Address - This field displays the MAC address of the PC that is managing  
the Router. If the MAC address is required, you can click the Clone MAC Address To  
button and this MAC address will fill in the WAN MAC Address field.  
Click Restore Factory MAC to restore the MAC address of WAN port to the factory default  
value.  
- 46 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Click the Save button to save your settings.  
Note:  
)
1. Only the PC on your LAN can use the MAC Address Clone function.  
2. If you change WAN MAC Address when the WAN connection is PPPoE, it will not take effect  
until the connection is re-established.  
4.6.3 LAN  
Choose menu “Network LAN”, and then you can configure the IP parameters of the LAN on  
the screen as below.  
Figure 4-17 LAN  
¾
¾
¾
¾
MAC Address - The physical address of the LAN ports, as seen from the LAN. The value  
can't be changed.  
IP Address - Enter the IP address of your Router in dotted-decimal notation (factory default:  
192.168.0.254).  
Subnet Mask - An address code that determines the size of the network. Normally use  
255.255.255.0 as the subnet mask.  
IGMP Proxy - The Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) feature allows your devices  
in LAN can watch TV.  
Note:  
)
1. If you change the IP Address of LAN, you must use the new IP Address to login to the Router.  
2. If the new LAN IP Address you set is not in the same subnet with the previous one, the IP  
Address pool in the DHCP server will be configured automaticallywhile the Virtual Server and  
DMZ Host will not take effect until they are re-configured.  
- 47 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
4.7 Wireless  
Figure 4-18 Wireless menu  
There are five submenus under the Wireless menu (shown in Figure 4-18): Wireless Settings,  
Wireless Security, Wireless MAC Filtering, Wireless Advanced and Wireless Statistics. Click  
any of them, and you will be able to configure the corresponding function.  
4.7.1 Wireless Settings  
Choose menu “Wireless Wireless Settings”, and then you can configure the basic settings  
for the wireless network on this page.  
Figure 4-19 Wireless Settings - Router  
¾
Wireless Network Name - Enter a string of up to 32 characters. The same name of SSID  
(Service Set Identification) must be assigned to all wireless devices in your network. The  
default SSID is set to be TP-LINK_XXXXXX (XXXXXX indicates the last unique six numbers  
of each Router’s MAC address). But it is recommended strongly that you change your  
networks name (SSID) to a different value. This value is case-sensitive. For example, TEST  
is NOT the same as test.  
¾
Region - Select your region from the pull-down list. This field specifies the region where the  
wireless function of the Router can be used. It may be illegal to use the wireless function of  
- 48 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
the Router in a region other than one of those specified in this field. If your country or region  
is not listed, please contact your local government agency for assistance.  
¾
Mode - Select the desired mode. The default setting is 11bgn mixed.  
11bg mixed - Select if you are using both 802.11b and 802.11g wireless clients.  
11bgn mixed - Select if you are using a mix of 802.11b, 11g, and 11n wireless clients.  
When 11bg mixed mode is selected, only 11bg mixed wireless stations can connect to the  
Router. It is strongly recommended that you set the Mode to 11bgn mixed, and all of  
802.11b/g/n wireless stations can connect to the Router.  
Note:  
)
If 11bg mixed mode is selected in the Mode field, the Channel Width selecting field will turn  
grey and the value will become 20M, which is unable to be changed.  
¾
¾
Channel Width - Select any channel width from the pull-down list. The default setting is  
automatic, which can automatically adjust the channel width for your clients.  
Channel - This field determines which operating frequency will be used. The default channel  
is set to Auto. It is not necessary to change the wireless channel unless you notice  
interference problems with another nearby access point.  
¾
¾
Enable Wireless Router Radio - The wireless radio of the Router can be enabled or disabled  
to allow wireless stations access. If enabled, the wireless stations will be able to access the  
Router. Otherwise, wireless stations will not be able to access the Router.  
Enable SSID Broadcast - If you select the Enable SSID Broadcast checkbox, the wireless  
router will broadcast its name (SSID) on the air.  
Be sure to click the Save button to save your settings on this page.  
Note:  
)
1. The operating distance or range of your wireless connection varies significantly based on the  
physical placement of the Router. For best results, place your Router.  
z
z
z
Near the center of the area in which your wireless stations will operate.  
In an elevated location such as a high shelf.  
Away from the potential sources of interference, such as PCs, microwaves, and cordless  
phones.  
z
Away from large metal surfaces.  
2. Failure to follow these guidelines can result in significant performance degradation or inability  
to wirelessly connect to the Router.  
- 49 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
4.7.2 Wireless Security  
Choose menu “Wireless Wireless Security”, and then you can configure the security  
settings of your wireless network.  
There are three wireless security modes supported by the Router: WPA/WPA2-Personal,  
WPA/WPA2-Enterprise and WEP (Wired Equivalent Privacy).  
Figure 4-20 Wireless Security  
¾
¾
Disable Security - The wireless security function can be enabled or disabled. If disabled, the  
wireless stations will be able to connect the Router without encryption. But it’s strongly  
recommended to choose one of the following modes to enable security.  
WPA-PSK/WPA2-Personal - It’s the WPA/WPA2 authentication type based on pre-shared  
passphrase.  
Version - you can choose the version of the WPA-PSK security on the drop-down list. The  
default setting is Automatic, which can select WPA-PSK (Pre-shared key of WPA) or  
WPA2-PSK (Pre-shared key of WPA) automatically based on the wireless station's  
capability and request.  
- 50 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Encryption - When WPA-PSK or WPA is set as the Authentication Type, you can select  
either Automatic, or TKIP or AES as Encryption.  
Note:  
)
If you check the WPA-PSK/WPA2-PSK radio button and choose TKIP encryption, you will  
find a notice in red as shown in Figure 4-21.  
Figure 4-21  
¾
WPA /WPA2-Enterprise - It’s based on Radius Server.  
Version - you can choose the version of the WPA security from the pull-down list. The  
default setting is Automatic, which can select WPA (Wi-Fi Protected Access) or WPA2  
(WPA version 2) automatically based on the wireless station's capability and request.  
Encryption - You can select Automatic, TKIP or AES.  
Radius Server IP - Enter the IP address of the Radius server.  
Radius Port - Enter the port that Radius server used.  
Radius Password - Enter the password for the Radius server.  
Group Key Update Period - Specify the group key update interval in seconds. The value  
should be 30 or above. Enter 0 to disable the update.  
¾
WEP - It is based on the IEEE 802.11 standard.  
Type - you can choose the type for the WEP security on the pull-down list. The default  
setting is Automatic, which can select Shared Key or Open System authentication type  
automatically based on the wireless station's capability and request.  
WEP Key Format - Hexadecimal and ASCII formats are provided here. Hexadecimal  
format stands for any combination of hexadecimal digits (0-9, a-f, A-F) in the specified  
length. ASCII format stands for any combination of keyboard characters in the specified  
length.  
WEP Key (Password) - Select which of the four keys will be used and enter the matching  
WEP key that you create. Make sure these values are identical on all wireless stations in  
your network.  
- 51 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Key Type - You can select the WEP key length (64-bit, or 128-bit, or 152-bit.) for  
encryption. "Disabled" means this WEP key entry is invalid.  
64-bit - You can enter 10 hexadecimal digits (any combination of 0-9, a-f, A-F, zero key is  
not promoted) or 5 ASCII characters.  
128-bit - You can enter 26 hexadecimal digits (any combination of 0-9, a-f, A-F, zero key is  
not promoted) or 13 ASCII characters.  
152-bit - You can enter 32 hexadecimal digits (any combination of 0-9, a-f, A-F, zero key is  
not promoted) or 16 ASCII characters.  
Note:  
)
If you do not set the key, the wireless security function is still disabled even if you have selected  
Shared Key as Authentication Type.  
Be sure to click the Save button to save your settings on this page.  
4.7.3 Wireless MAC Filtering  
Choose menu “Wireless Wireless MAC Filtering”, and then you can control the wireless  
access by configuring the Wireless MAC Filtering function, as shown in Figure 4-22.  
Figure 4-22 Wireless MAC Filtering  
To filter wireless users by MAC Address, click Enable. The default setting is Disable.  
¾
¾
¾
MAC Address - The wireless station's MAC address that you want to access.  
Status - The status of this entry, either Enabled or Disable.  
Description - A simple description of the wireless station.  
To Add a Wireless MAC Address filtering entry, click the Add New… button. The "Add or Modify  
Wireless MAC Address Filtering entry" page will appear, shown in Figure 4-23:  
- 52 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure 4-23 Add or Modify Wireless MAC Address Filtering entry  
To add or modify a MAC Address Filtering entry, follow these instructions:  
1. Enter the appropriate MAC Address into the MAC Address field. The format of the MAC  
Address is XX-XX-XX-XX-XX-XX (X is any hexadecimal digit). For example:  
00-0A-EB-B0-00-0B.  
2. Give a simple description for the wireless station in the Description field. For example:  
Wireless station A.  
3. Select Enabled or Disabled for this entry on the Status pull-down list.  
4. Click the Save button to save this entry.  
To modify or delete an existing entry:  
1. Click the Modify in the entry you want to modify. If you want to delete the entry, click the  
Delete.  
2. Modify the information.  
3. Click the Save button.  
Click the Enable All button to make all entries enabled  
Click the Disable All button to make all entries disabled.  
Click the Delete All button to delete all entries.  
Click the Next button to go to the next page.  
Click the Previous button to return to the previous page.  
For example: If you desire that the wireless station A with MAC address 00-0A-EB-B0-00-0B and  
the wireless station B with MAC address 00-0A-EB-00-07-5F are able to access the Router, but all  
the other wireless stations cannot access the Router, you can configure the Wireless MAC  
Address Filtering list by following these steps:  
1. Click the Enabled button to enable this function.  
2. Select the radio button “Allow the stations specified by any enabled entries in the list to  
access” for Filtering Rules.  
3. Delete all or disable all entries if there are any entries already.  
- 53 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
4. Click the Add New... button.  
1) Enter the MAC address 00-0A-EB-B0-00-0B/00-0A-EB-00-07-5F in the MAC Address field.  
2) Enter wireless station A/B in the Description field.  
3) Select Enabled in the Status pull-down list.  
4) Click the Save button.  
5) Click the Back button.  
The filtering rules that configured should be similar to the following list:  
Figure 4-24 Filtering Rules  
4.7.4 Wireless Advanced  
Choose menu “Wireless Wireless Advanced”, and then you can configure the advanced  
settings of your wireless network.  
Figure 4-25 Wireless Advanced  
¾
¾
Transmit Power - Here you can specify the transmit power of Router. You can select High,  
Middle or Low which you would like. High is the default setting and is recommended.  
Beacon Interval - Enter a value between 20-1000 milliseconds for Beacon Interval here.  
The beacons are the packets sent by the Router to synchronize a wireless network. Beacon  
Interval value determines the time interval of the beacons. The default value is 100.  
¾
RTS Threshold - Here you can specify the RTS (Request to Send) Threshold. If the packet  
is larger than the specified RTS Threshold size, the Router will send RTS frames to a  
- 54 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
particular receiving station and negotiate the sending of a data frame. The default value is  
2346.  
¾
¾
Fragmentation Threshold - This value is the maximum size determining whether packets  
will be fragmented. Setting the Fragmentation Threshold too low may result in poor network  
performance because of excessive packets. 2346 is the default setting and is  
recommended.  
DTIM Interval - This value determines the interval of the Delivery Traffic Indication Message  
(DTIM). A DTIM field is a countdown field informing clients of the next window for listening to  
broadcast and multicast messages. When the Router has buffered broadcast or multicast  
messages for associated clients, it sends the next DTIM with a DTIM Interval value. You can  
specify the value between 1-255 Beacon Intervals. The default value is 1, which indicates  
the DTIM Interval is the same as Beacon Interval.  
¾
¾
¾
Enable WMM - WMM function can guarantee the packets with high-priority messages being  
transmitted preferentially. It is strongly recommended enabled.  
Enable Short GI - This function is recommended for it will increase the data capacity by  
reducing the guard interval time.  
Enable AP Isolation - This function isolate all connected wireless stations so that wireless  
stations cannot access each other through WLAN. This function will be disabled if  
WDS/Bridge is enabled.  
Note:  
)
If you are not familiar with the setting items in this page, it's strongly recommended to keep the  
provided default values; otherwise it may result in lower wireless network performance.  
4.7.5 Wireless Statistics  
Choose menu “Wireless Wireless Statistics”, and then you can see the MAC Address,  
Current Status, Received Packets and Sent Packets for each connected wireless station.  
Figure 4-26 Wireless Statistics  
¾
MAC Address - The connected wireless station's MAC address  
- 55 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
¾
Current Status - The connected wireless station's running status, one of STA-AUTH /  
STA-ASSOC / STA-JOINED / WPA / WPA-PSK / WPA2 / WPA2-PSK / AP-UP / AP-DOWN /  
Disconnected  
¾
¾
¾
Received Packets - Packets received by the station  
Sent Packets - Packets sent by the station.  
Configure - The button is used for loading the item to the Wireless MAC Filtering list.  
Allow - If the Wireless MAC Filtering function enable, allow the station to access.  
Deny - If the Wireless MAC Filtering function enable, deny the station to access.  
You cannot change any of the values on this page. To update this page and to show the current  
connected wireless stations, click on the Refresh button.  
If the numbers of connected wireless stations go beyond one page, click the Next button to go to  
the next page and click the Previous button to return the previous page.  
Note:  
)
This page will be refreshed automatically every 5 seconds.  
4.8 DHCP  
Figure 4-27 The DHCP menu  
There are three submenus under the DHCP menu (shown in Figure 4-27), DHCP Settings,  
DHCP Clients List and Address Reservation. Click any of them, and you will be able to  
configure the corresponding function.  
4.8.1 DHCP Settings  
Choose menu “DHCP DHCP Settings”, and then you can configure the DHCP Server on the  
page as shown in Figure 4-28. The Router is set up by default as a DHCP (Dynamic Host  
Configuration Protocol) server, which provides the TCP/IP configuration for all the PC(s) that are  
connected to the Router on the LAN.  
- 56 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure 4-28 DHCP Settings  
¾
DHCP Server - Enable or Disable the DHCP server. If you disable the Server, you must  
have another DHCP server within your network or else you must configure the computer  
manually.  
¾
¾
¾
Start IP Address - Specify an IP address for the DHCP Server to start with when assigning  
IP addresses. 192.168.0.100 is the default start address.  
End IP Address - Specify an IP address for the DHCP Server to end with when assigning IP  
addresses. 192.168.0.199 is the default end address.  
Address Lease Time - The Address Lease Time is the amount of time a network user will  
be allowed connection to the Router with their current dynamic IP Address. Enter the  
amount of time in minutes and the user will be "leased" this dynamic IP Address. After the  
time is up, the user will be automatically assigned a new dynamic IP address. The range of  
the time is 1 ~ 2880 minutes. The default value is 120 minutes.  
¾
Default Gateway (Optional) - It is suggested to input the IP address of the LAN port of the  
Router. The default value is 192.168.0.254.  
¾
¾
Default Domain (Optional) - Input the domain name of your network.  
Primary DNS - (Optional) Input the DNS IP address provided by your ISP or consult your  
ISP. Or consult your ISP.  
¾
Secondary DNS (Optional) - Input the IP address of another DNS server if your ISP  
provides two DNS servers.  
Note:  
)
To use the DHCP server function of the Router, you must configure all computers on the LAN as  
"Obtain an IP Address automatically".  
- 57 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
4.8.2 DHCP Client List  
Choose menu “DHCP DHCP Client List”, and then you can view the information about the  
clients attached to the Router in the screen as shown in Figure 4-29.  
Figure 4-29 DHCP Client List  
¾
¾
¾
¾
Client Name - The name of the DHCP client  
MAC Address - The MAC address of the DHCP client  
Assigned IP - The IP address that the Router has allocated to the DHCP client  
Lease Time - The time of the DHCP client leased. After the dynamic IP address has expired,  
a new dynamic IP address will be automatically assigned to the user.  
You cannot change any of the values on this page. To update this page and to show the current  
attached devices, click the Refresh button.  
4.8.3 Address Reservation  
Choose menu “DHCP Address Reservation”, and then you can view and add a reserved  
address for clients via the next screen (shown in Figure 4-30).When you specify a reserved IP  
address for a PC on the LAN, that PC will always receive the same IP address each time when it  
accesses the DHCP server. Reserved IP addresses should be assigned to the servers that  
require permanent IP settings.  
Figure 4-30 Address Reservation  
¾
¾
¾
MAC Address - The MAC address of the PC for which you want to reserve an IP address.  
Reserved IP Address - The IP address reserved for the PC by the Router.  
Status - The status of this entry, either Enabled or Disabled.  
- 58 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Modify - To modify or delete an existing entry.  
To Reserve an IP address:  
¾
1. Click the Add New… button. Then will pop-up.  
2. Enter the MAC address (in XX-XX-XX-XX-XX-XX format.) and IP address (in dotted-decimal  
notation) of the computer for which you want to reserve an IP address.  
3. Click the Save button.  
Figure 4-31 Add or Modify an Address Reservation Entry  
To modify or delete an existing entry:  
1. Click the Modify in the entry you want to modify. If you want to delete the entry, click the  
Delete.  
2. Modify the information.  
3. Click the Save button.  
Click the Enable/Disable All button to make all entries enabled/disabled.  
Click the Delete All button to delete all entries.  
Click the Next button to go to the next page and Click the Previous button to return the previous  
page.  
4.9 USB Settings  
Figure 4-32 The USB Settings menu  
There are three submenus under the USB Settings menu (shown in Figure 4-32), Storage  
Sharing, Media Server and User Accounts. Click any of them, and you will be able to configure  
the corresponding functions.  
- 59 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
4.9.1 Storage Sharing  
Choose menu “USB SettingsStorage Sharing”, you can configure a USB disk drive attached  
to the router and view volume and share such properties as share name, capacity, used space,  
and free space on this page as shown below.  
Figure 4-33 Storage Sharing  
¾
¾
Service Status - Indicates the Network Sharing service's current status. You can click the  
Start button to start the Storage Sharing service and click the Stop button to stop it.  
Volume - The volume name of the USB drive the users have access to. Volume 1-8 is  
mapping to USB port1, and Volume 9-16 is mapping to USB port2.  
¾
¾
¾
¾
¾
Capacity - The storage capacity of the USB driver.  
Used - The used space of the USB driver.  
Free - The available space of the USB driver.  
Use% - The percentage of the used space.  
Shared - Indicates the shared or non-shared status of the volume. When the volume is  
shared, you can click the Disable to stop sharing the volume; when volume is non-shared,  
you can click the Enable button to share the volume.  
Click the Start button to start the Network Sharing service.  
Click the Stop button to stop the Network Sharing service.  
Click the Eject Disk button to safely remove the USB storage device that is connected to USB  
port. This takes the drive offline. A message (as shown in Figure 4-34) will appear on your web  
browser when it is safe to detach the USB disk.  
- 60 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure 4-34 Safe Unplug Message  
Click the Rescan button to start a new scan.  
Follow the instructions below to set up your router as a file server:  
1. Plug an external USB hard disk drive or USB flash drive into this router.  
2. Click the Rescan button to find the USB drive that has been attached to the router.  
3. Click the Start button to start the Storage Sharing service.  
4. Click the Enable button under Shared to enable the disk to share.  
5. Click the Open the disk to visit the sharing disk.  
Note:  
)
1. The router can automatically locate new USB drive. But to display the information about your  
USB device, you need to click the Rescan button manually.  
2. The new settings will not take effect until you restart the service.  
3. To unplug the USB drive, click Eject Disk button first. Simply pulling USB drive out of the  
USB port can cause damage to the device and loss of data.  
4. Mounted volumes of each USB port are subject to the 8-volume limit. So you cannot access  
more than 8 volumes on the USB storage device.  
5. If you change the storage settings during the storage connection is established, then the  
changes will not take effect until the router or the client is rebooted.  
4.9.2 Media Server  
Choose menu “USB SettingsMedia Server”, you can create media server that allows you to  
share stored content with other computers and devices on your home network and on the Internet.  
- 61 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure 4-35 Media Server Setting  
¾
¾
Server Name - The name of this Media Server.  
Server Status - Indicates the Media Server’s current status, started or stopped. You can  
click the Start button to start the Media Server and click the Stop button to stop it.  
Name - The display name of this folder.  
¾
¾
¾
¾
File System - The file system type on the partition can be FAT32 or NTFS.  
Folder - The real full path of the specified folder.  
Delete - You can delete the share folder by click Delete.  
To set up your media server, please follow the instructions below:  
1. Plug an external USB hard disk drive or USB flash drive into this router, and then the screen  
will appear as shown in Figure 4-36.  
Figure 4-36 Media Server Setting  
2. Click the Start button to start the media server, and then the screen will appear as shown in  
Figure 4-37 Media Server Setting  
- 62 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
3. Click the Add share folder button to specify a folder as the search path of media server. The  
screen will then appear as shown in Figure 4-38.  
Figure 4-38 Add New Folder  
¾
¾
Display Name - You can enter a display name for the share folder.  
Share entire partition - Choose this option and then the folders contained in this  
partition will all be shared.  
¾
¾
¾
¾
¾
Folder Location- Displays the location of this folder.  
Select - Check the radio button to select the folder to share.  
Folder - Displays folders that are in current path.  
Upper - Click this button to get into the upper folder.  
Save - Click this button to save your settings and the page will be redirected to the  
media server configuration page.  
¾
Back - Click this button to discard the settings and just go to the media server  
configuration page.  
4. Click the Scan All button to scan all the share folders immediately. You can also select the  
Auto-scan, at same time, select an auto scan interval time by drop-down list. In this case, the  
media server will auto scan the share folders.  
Note:  
)
The max share folders number is 6. If you want share a new folder when the number has been  
reached to be 6, you can delete a share folder and then add a new one.  
4.9.3 User Accounts  
You can specify the user name and password for Storage Sharing users on this page. Storage  
Sharing users can use Internet Explorer to access files on the USB drive.  
- 63 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
There are two default user accounts that can access the Storage Sharing. They are Administrator  
and Guest (as shown in Figure 4-39). Administrator has read/write access to Storage Sharing and  
can access FTP Server while Guest has read-only access to Storage Sharing and cannot access  
FTP Server.  
Figure 4-39 User Account Management  
Only Administrator can use a Web browser to transfer the files from a PC to the Writable shared  
volume on the USB drive.  
To add a new user account, please follow the steps below:  
1. Click Add New User button, and the screen will appear as shown in Figure 4-40.  
2. Self-define a User Name.  
3. Enter the password in the Password field.  
4. Choose the Storage Authority from the drop-down list, Read and Write or Read Only.  
Figure 4-40 Add or Modify User Account  
¾
¾
User Name - Type the user name that you want to give access to the USB drive. The  
user name must be composed of alphanumeric symbols not exceeding 15 characters in  
length.  
Password - Enter the password in the Password field. The password must be composed  
of alphanumeric symbols not exceeding 15 characters in length. For security purposes,  
the password for each user account is not displayed.  
- 64 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
¾
Storage Authority – Choose Read and Write or Read Only from the drop-down list to  
assign access authority of Storage Sharing to the user.  
¾
¾
Save - You can click the Save button to save your settings.  
Back - You can click the Back button to discard the settings and just go to the media  
server configuration page.  
Note:  
)
Please restart the service for the new settings to take effect.  
If you cannot use the new user name and password to access the shares, press Windows logo +  
R to open the Run dialog box and type net use \\192.168.0.254 /delete /yes and press Enter.  
(192.168.0.254 is your router's LAN IP address. If the LAN IP of the modem connected with your  
router is 192.168.1.x, the default LAN IP of the router will automatically switch from 192.168.0.254  
to 192.168.1.254 to avoid IP conflict; in this case, please try net use \\192.168.1.254 /delete /  
yes.)  
4.10Forwarding  
Figure 4-41 The Forwarding menu  
There are four submenus under the Forwarding menu (shown in Figure 4-41): Virtual Servers,  
Port Triggering, DMZ and UPnP. Click any of them, and you will be able to configure the  
corresponding function.  
4.10.1 Virtual Servers  
Choose menu “Forwarding Virtual Servers”, and then you can view and add virtual servers  
in the screen as shown in Figure 4-42. Virtual servers can be used for setting up public services  
on your LAN, such as DNS, Email and FTP. A virtual server is defined as a service port, and all  
requests from the Internet to this service port will be redirected to the computer specified by the  
server IP. Any PC that was used for a virtual server must have a static or reserved IP Address  
because its IP Address may be changed when using the DHCP function.  
- 65 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure 4-42 Virtual Servers  
¾
¾
Service Port - The numbers of External Ports. You can type a service port or a range of  
service ports (in XXX – YYY format, XXX is the start port number, YYY is the end port  
number).  
Internal Port - The Internal Service Port number of the PC running the service application.  
You can leave it blank if the Internal Port is the same as the Service Port, or enter a  
specific port number when Service Port is a single one.  
¾
¾
IP Address - The IP Address of the PC providing the service application.  
Protocol - The protocol used for this application, either TCP, UDP, or All (all protocols  
supported by the Router).  
¾
¾
Status - The status of this entry, either Enabled or Disabled.  
Modify - To modify or delete an existing entry.  
To setup a virtual server entry:  
1. Click the Add New… button, the next screen will pop-up as shown in Figure 4-43.  
2. Select the service port you want to use from the Common Service Port list. If the Common  
Service Port list does not have the service that you want to use, type the service port  
number or service port range in the Service Port box.  
3. Type the IP Address of the computer in the IP Address box.  
4. Select the protocol used for this application, either TCP, UDP, or All.  
5. Select the Enabled to enable the virtual server.  
6. Click the Save button.  
- 66 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure 4-43 Add or Modify a Virtual Server Entry  
Note:  
)
If your computer or server has more than one type of available service, please select another  
service, and enter the same IP Address for that computer or server.  
To modify or delete an existing entry:  
1. Click the Modify in the entry you want to modify. If you want to delete the entry, click the  
Delete.  
2. Modify the information.  
3. Click the Save button.  
Click the Enable/Disable All button to make all entries enabled/disabled.  
Click the Delete All button to delete all entries.  
Click the Next button to go to the next page and click the Previous button to return the previous  
page.  
Note:  
)
If you set the service port of the virtual server as 80, you must set the Web management port on  
Security Remote Management” page to be any other value except 80 such as 8080.  
Otherwise there will be a conflict to disable the virtual server.  
4.10.2 Port Triggering  
Choose menu “Forwarding Port Triggering”, and then you can view and add port triggering  
in the screen as shown in Figure 4-44. Some applications require multiple connections, like  
Internet games, video conferencing, Internet calling and so on. These applications cannot work  
with a pure NAT Router. Port Triggering is used for some of these applications that can work with  
an NAT Router.  
- 67 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure 4-44 Port Triggering  
Once the Router is configured, the operation is as follows:  
1. A local host makes an outgoing connection using a destination port number defined in the  
Trigger Port field.  
2. The Router records this connection, opens the incoming port or ports associated with this  
entry in the Port Triggering table, and associates them with the local host.  
3. When necessarythe external host will be able to connect to the local host using one of the  
ports defined in the Incoming Ports field.  
¾
Trigger Port - The port for outgoing traffic. An outgoing connection using this port will trigger  
this rule.  
¾
¾
Trigger Protocol - The protocol used for Trigger Ports, either TCP, UDP, or All (all  
protocols supported by the Router).  
Incoming Ports - The port or port range used by the remote system when it responds to the  
outgoing request. A response using one of these ports will be forwarded to the PC that  
triggered this rule. You can input at most 5 groups of ports (or port sections). Every group of  
ports must be set apart with ",". For example, 2000-2038, 2050-2051, 2085, 3010-3030.  
¾
Incoming Protocol - The protocol used for Incoming Ports Range, either TCP or UDP, or  
ALL (all protocols supported by the Router).  
¾
¾
Status - The status of this entry, either Enabled or Disabled.  
Modify - To modify or delete an existing entry.  
To add a new rule, follow the steps below:  
1. Click the Add New… button, the next screen will pop-up as shown in Figure 4-45.  
2. Select a common application from the Common Applications drop-down list, then the  
Trigger Port field and the Incoming Ports field will be automatically filled. If the Common  
Applications do not have the application you need, enter the Trigger Port and the  
Incoming Ports manually.  
3. Select the protocol used for Trigger Port from the Trigger Protocol drop-down list, either  
TCP, UDP, or All.  
4. Select the protocol used for Incoming Ports from the Incoming Protocol drop-down list,  
either TCP or UDP, or All.  
- 68 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
5. Select Enabled in Status field.  
6. Click the Save button to save the new rule.  
Figure 4-45 Add or Modify a Port Triggering Entry  
To modify or delete an existing entry:  
1. Click the Modify in the entry you want to modify. If you want to delete the entry, click the  
Delete.  
2. Modify the information.  
3. Click the Save button.  
Click the Enable All button to make all entries enabled.  
Click the Disable All button to make all entries disabled.  
Click the Delete All button to delete all entries.  
Note:  
)
1. When the trigger connection is released, the corresponding opening ports will be closed.  
2. Each rule is allowed to be used only by one host on LAN synchronously. The trigger  
connection of other hosts on LAN will be refused.  
3. Incoming Port Range cannot overlap each other.  
4.10.3 DMZ  
Choose menu “Forwarding DMZ”, and then you can view and configure DMZ host in the  
screen as shown in Figure 4-46. The DMZ host feature allows one local host to be exposed to the  
Internet for a special-purpose service such as Internet gaming or videoconferencing. DMZ host  
forwards all the ports at the same time. Any PC whose port is being forwarded must have its  
DHCP client function disabled and should have a new static IP Address assigned to it because its  
IP Address may be changed when using the DHCP function.  
- 69 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure 4-46 DMZ  
To assign a computer or server to be a DMZ server:  
1. Check the Enable radio button.  
2. Enter the IP Address of a local host in the DMZ Host IP Address field.  
3. Click the Save button.  
Note:  
)
After you set the DMZ host, the firewall related to the host will not work.  
4.10.4 UPnP  
Choose menu “Forwarding UPnP”, and then you can view the information about UPnP  
(Universal Plug and Play) in the screen as shown in Figure 4-47. The UPnP feature allows the  
devices, such as Internet computers, to access the local host resources or devices as needed.  
UPnP devices can be automatically discovered by the UPnP service application on the LAN.  
Figure 4-47 UPnP  
¾
¾
Current UPnP Status - UPnP can be enabled or disabled by clicking the Enable or Disable  
button.  
Current UPnP Settings List - This table displays the current UPnP information.  
App Description - The description provided by the application in the UPnP request.  
External Port - The external port the Router opens for the application.  
Protocol - The type of protocol the Router opens for the application.  
Internal Port - The Internal port the Router opens for local host.  
IP Address - The IP address of the UPnP device that is currently accessing the Router.  
- 70 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Status - The status of the port is displayed here. “Enabled” means that the port is still  
active. Otherwise, the port is inactive.  
Click Refresh to update the Current UPnP Settings List.  
4.11Security  
Figure 4-48 The Security menu  
There are four submenus under the Security menu as shown in Figure 4-48: Basic Security,  
Advanced Security, Local Management and Remote Management. Click any of them, and you  
will be able to configure the corresponding function.  
4.11.1 Basic Security  
Choose menu “Security Basic Security”, you can configure the basic security in the screen  
as shown in Figure 4-49.  
Figure 4-49 Basic Security  
¾
Firewall - A firewall protects your network from the outside world. Here you can enable or  
disable the Router’s firewall.  
z
SPI Firewall - SPI (Stateful Packet Inspection, also known as dynamic packet filtering)  
helps to prevent cyber attacks by tracking more state per session. It validates that the  
- 71 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
traffic passing through the session conforms to the protocol. SPI Firewall is enabled by  
factory default. If you want all the computers on the LAN exposed to the outside world,  
you can disable it.  
¾
VPN - VPN Passthrough must be enabled if you want to allow VPN tunnels using IPSec,  
PPTP, or L2TP protocols to pass through the Router’s firewall.  
z
z
z
PPTP Passthrough - Point-to-Point Tunneling Protocol (PPTP) allows the Point-to-Point  
Protocol (PPP) to be tunneled through an IP network. To allow PPTP tunnels to pass  
through the Router, keep the default, Enable.  
L2TP Passthrough - Layer 2 Tunneling Protocol (L2TP) is the method used to enable  
Point-to-Point sessions via the Internet on the Layer 2 level. To allow L2TP tunnels to  
pass through the Router, keep the default, Enable.  
IPSec Passthrough - Internet Protocol Security (IPSec) is a suite of protocols for  
ensuring private, secure communications over Internet Protocol (IP) networks, through  
the use of cryptographic security services. To allow IPSec tunnels to pass through the  
Router, keep the default, Enable.  
¾
ALG - It is recommended to enable Application Layer Gateway (ALG) because ALG allows  
customized Network Address Translation (NAT) traversal filters to be plugged into the  
gateway to support address and port translation for certain application layer "control/data"  
protocols such as FTP, TFTP, H323 etc.  
z
z
z
FTP ALG - To allow FTP clients and servers to transfer data across NAT, keep the  
default Enable.  
TFTP ALG - To allow TFTP clients and servers to transfer data across NAT, keep the  
default Enable.  
H323 ALG - To allow Microsoft NetMeeting clients to communicate across NAT, keep  
the default Enable.  
Click the Save button to save your settings.  
4.11.2 Advanced Security  
Choose menu “Security Advanced Security”, you can protect the Router from being  
attacked by TCP-SYN Flood, UDP Flood and ICMP-Flood in the screen as shown in Figure 4-50.  
- 72 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure 4-50 Advanced Security  
¾
¾
Packets Statistics Interval (5~60) - The default value is 10. Select a value between 5 and  
60 seconds from the drop-down list. The Packets Statistics Interval value indicates the time  
section of the packets statistics. The result of the statistics is used for analysis by SYN Flood,  
UDP Flood and ICMP-Flood.  
DoS Protection - Denial of Service protection. Check the Enable or Disable button to  
enable or disable the DoS protection function. Only when it is enabled, will the flood filters be  
enabled.  
Note:  
)
Dos Protection will take effect only when the Traffic Statistics in “System Tool Traffic  
Statistics” is enabled.  
¾
¾
Enable ICMP-FLOOD Attack Filtering - Enable or Disable the ICMP-FLOOD Attack  
Filtering.  
ICMP-FLOOD Packets Threshold (5~3600) - The default value is 50. Enter a value  
between 5 ~ 3600. When the current ICMP-FLOOD Packets number is beyond the set value,  
the Router will startup the blocking function immediately.  
¾
¾
Enable UDP-FLOOD Filtering - Enable or Disable the UDP-FLOOD Filtering.  
UDP-FLOOD Packets Threshold (5~3600) - The default value is 500. Enter a value  
between 5 ~ 3600. When the current UPD-FLOOD Packets number is beyond the set value,  
the Router will startup the blocking function immediately.  
- 73 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
¾
¾
Enable TCP-SYN-FLOOD Attack Filtering - Enable or Disable the TCP-SYN-FLOOD  
Attack Filtering.  
TCP-SYN-FLOOD Packets Threshold (5~3600) - The default value is 50. Enter a value  
between 5 ~ 3600. When the current TCP-SYN-FLOOD Packets numbers is beyond the set  
value, the Router will startup the blocking function immediately.  
¾
¾
Ignore Ping Packet From WAN Port - Enable or Disable Ignore Ping Packet From WAN  
Port. The default setting is disabled. If enabled, the ping packet from the Internet cannot  
access the Router.  
Forbid Ping Packet From LAN Port - Enable or Disable Forbid Ping Packet From LAN Port.  
The default setting is disabled. If enabled, the ping packet from LAN cannot access the  
Router. This function can be used to defend against some viruses.  
Click the Save button to save the settings.  
Click the Blocked DoS Host List button to display the DoS host table by blocking.  
4.11.3 Local Management  
Choose menu “Security Local Management”, you can configure the management rule in the  
screen as shown in Figure 4-51. The management feature allows you to deny computers in LAN  
from accessing the Router.  
Figure 4-51 Local Management  
By default, the radio button “All the PCs on the LAN are allowed to access the Router's  
Web-Based Utility” is checked. If you want to allow PCs with specific MAC Addresses to access  
the Setup page of the Router's Web-Based Utility locally from inside the network, check the radio  
button “Only the PCs listed can browse the built-in web pages to perform Administrator  
tasks”, and then enter each MAC Address in a separate field. The format for the MAC Address is  
XX-XX-XX-XX-XX-XX (X is any hexadecimal digit). Only the PCs with MAC address listed can  
- 74 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
use the password to browse the built-in web pages to perform Administrator tasks while all the  
others will be blocked.  
After click the Add button, your PC's MAC Address will be placed in the list above.  
Click the Save button to save your settings.  
Note:  
)
If your PC is blocked but you want to access the Router again, press and hold the WPS button  
for more than 5 seconds to reset the Router to factory defaults.  
4.11.4 Remote Management  
You can configure the Remote Management function on this page. This feature allows you to  
manage your Router from a remote location, via the Internet.  
Figure 4-52 Remote Management  
¾
Web Management Port - Web browser access normally uses the standard HTTP service  
port 80. This router’s default remote management Web port number is 80. For greater  
security, you can change the remote management Web interface to a custom port by  
entering that number in this box provided. Choose a number between 1024 and 65535, but  
do not use the number of any common service port.  
¾
Remote Management IP Address - This is the current address you will use when  
accessing your router from the Internet. The default IP Address is 0.0.0.0. It means this  
function is disabled. To enable this function, change the default IP Address to another IP  
Address as desired.  
To access the router, you will type your router's WAN IP Address into your browser's Address (in  
IE) or Location (in Navigator) box, followed by a colon and the custom port number. For example,  
if your Router's WAN address is 202.96.12.8 and you use port number 8080, enter in your  
browser: http://202.96.12.8:8080. You will be asked for the router's password. After successfully  
entering the password, you will be able to access the router's Web-based utility.  
Note:  
)
Be sure to change the router's default password to a very secure password.  
- 75 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
4.12 Parental Control  
Choose menu “Parental Control”, and you can configure the parental control in the screen as  
shown in Figure 4-53. The Parental Control function can be used to control the internet activities  
of the child, limit the child to access certain websites and restrict the time of surfing.  
Figure 4-53 Parental Control Settings  
¾
¾
Parental Control - Check Enable if you want this function to take effect, otherwise check  
Disable.  
MAC Address of Parental PC - In this field, enter the MAC address of the controlling PC, or  
you can make use of the Copy To Above button below.  
¾
MAC Address of Your PC - This field displays the MAC address of the PC that is managing  
this Router. If the MAC Address of your adapter is registered, you can click the Copy To  
Above button to fill this address to the MAC Address of Parental PC field above.  
¾
¾
Website Description - Description of the allowed website for the PC controlled.  
Schedule - The time period allowed for the PC controlled to access the Internet. For detailed  
information, please go to “Access ControlSchedule”.  
¾
Modify - Here you can edit or delete an existing entry.  
To add a new entry, please follow the steps below.  
1. Click the Add New… button and the next screen will pop-up as shown in Figure 4-54.  
2. Enter the MAC address of the PC (e.g. 00-11-22-33-44-AA) you’d like to control in the MAC  
Address of Child PC field. Or you can choose the MAC address from the All Address in  
Current LAN drop-down list.  
3. Give a description (e.g. Allow Google) for the website allowed to be accessed in the Website  
Description field.  
- 76 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
4. Enter the allowed domain name of the website, either the full name or the keywords (e.g.  
google) in the Allowed Domain Name field. Any domain name with keywords in it  
(e.g.www.google.com) will be allowed.  
5. Select from the Effective Time drop-down list the schedule (e.g. Schedule_1) you want the  
entry to take effect. If there are not suitable schedules for you, click the Schedule in red  
below to go to the Advance Schedule Settings page and create the schedule you need.  
6. In the Status field, you can select Enabled or Disabled to enable or disable your entry.  
7. Click the Save button.  
Click the Enable All button to enable all the rules in the list.  
Click the Disable All button to disable all the rules in the list.  
Click the Delete All button to delete all the entries in the table.  
Click the Next button to go to the next page, or click the Previous button return to the previous  
page.  
Figure 4-54 Add or Modify Parental Control Entry  
For example: If you desire that the child PC with MAC address 00-11-22-33-44-AA can access  
www.google.com on Saturday only while the parent PC with MAC address 00-11-22-33-44-BB is  
without any restriction, you should follow the settings below.  
1. Click Parental Control” menu on the left to enter the Parental Control Settings page. Check  
Enable and enter the MAC address 00-11-22-33-44-BB in the MAC Address of Parental PC  
field.  
- 77 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
2. Click Access Restriction Schedule” on the left to enter the Schedule Settings page.  
Click Add New... button to create a new schedule with Schedule Description is Schedule_1,  
Day is Sat and Time is all day-24 hours.  
3. Click Parental Control” menu on the left to go back to the Add or Modify Parental Control  
Entry page:  
z Click Add New... button.  
z Enter 00-11-22-33-44-AA in the MAC Address of Child PC field.  
z Enter “Allow Google” in the Website Description field.  
z Enter “www.google.com” in the Allowed Domain Name field.  
z Select “Schedule_1” you create just now from the Effective Time drop-down list.  
z In Status field, select Enable.  
4. Click Save to complete the settings.  
Then you will go back to the Parental Control Settings page and see the following list, as shown in  
Figure 4-55  
4.13 Access Control  
Figure 4-56 The Access Control menu  
There are four submenus under the Access Restriction menu as shown in Figure 4-56: Rule,  
Host, Target and Schedule. Click any of them, and you will be able to configure the  
corresponding function.  
4.13.1 Rule  
Choose menu “Access ControlRule”, you can view and set Access Restriction rules in the  
screen as shown in Figure 4-57.  
- 78 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure 4-57 Access Control Rule Management  
¾
Enable Internet Access Control - Select the check box to enable the Internet Access  
Restriction function, so the Default Filter Policy can take effect.  
¾
¾
¾
¾
¾
Rule Name - Here displays the name of the rule and this name is unique.  
Host - Here displays the host selected in the corresponding rule.  
Target - Here displays the target selected in the corresponding rule.  
Schedule - Here displays the schedule selected in the corresponding rule.  
Action - Here displays the action the Router takes to deal with the packets. It could be Allow  
or Deny. Allow means that the Router permits the packets to go through the Router. Deny  
means that the Router rejects the packets to go through the Router.  
¾
¾
Status - This field displays the status of the rule. Enabled means the rule will take effect,  
Disabled means the rule will not take effect.  
Modify - Here you can edit or delete an existing rule.  
To add a new rule, please follow the steps below.  
1. Click the Add New… button and the next screen will pop-up as shown in Figure 4-58.  
2. Give a name (e.g. Rule_1) for the rule in the Rule Name field.  
3. Select a host from the Host drop-down list or choose “Click Here To Add New Host List”.  
4. Select a target from the Target drop-sown list or choose “Click Here To Add New Target  
List”.  
5. Select a schedule from the Schedule drop-down list or choose “Click Here To Add New  
Schedule”.  
- 79 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
6. In the Action field, select Deny or Allow.  
7. In the Status field, select Enabled or Disabled to enable or disable your entry.  
8. Click the Save button.  
Click the Enable All button to enable all the rules in the list.  
Click the Disable All button to disable all the rules in the list.  
Click the Delete All button to delete all the entries in the table.  
You can change the entry’s order as desired. Fore entries are before hind entries. Enter the ID  
number in the first box you want to move and another ID number in second box you want to move  
to, and then click the Move button to change the entry’s order.  
Click the Next button to go to the next page, or click the Previous button return to the previous  
page.  
Figure 4-58 Add or Modify Internet Access Restriction Entry  
For example: If you desire to allow the host with MAC address 00-11-22-33-44-AA to access  
www.google.com only from 18:00 to 20:00 on Saturday and Sunday, and forbid other hosts in  
the LAN to access the Internet, you should follow the settings below:  
1. Click Access Control Host” in the left to enter the Host Settings page. Add a new entry  
with the Host Description is Host_1 and MAC Address is 00-11-22-33-44-AA.  
2. Click Access Control Target” in the left to enter the Target Settings page. Add a new  
entry with the Target Description is Target_1 and Domain Name is www.google.com.  
3. Click Access Control Schedule” in the left to enter the Schedule Settings page. Add a  
new entry with the Schedule Description is Schedule_1, Day is Sat and Sun, Start Time is  
1800 and Stop Time is 2000.  
4. Click Access Control Rule” in the left to return to the Access Restriction Rule  
Management page. Select “Enable Internet Access Restriction” and choose "Deny the  
packets not specified by any access Restriction policy to pass through the Router".  
5. Click Add New... button to add a new rule as follows:  
- 80 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
z
In Rule Name field, create a name for the rule. Note that this name should be unique, for  
example Rule_1.  
z
z
z
z
z
z
In Host field, select Host_1.  
In Target field, select Target_1.  
In Schedule field, select Schedule_1.  
In Action field, select Allow.  
In Status field, select Enabled.  
Click Save to complete the settings.  
Then you will go back to the Access Restriction Rule Management page and see the following list.  
Figure 4-59 Rule Settings  
4.13.2 Host  
Choose menu “Access Control Host”, you can view and set a Host list in the screen as  
shown in Figure 4-60. The host list is necessary for the Access Restriction Rule.  
Figure 4-60 Host Settings  
¾
¾
¾
Host Description - Here displays the description of the host and this description is unique.  
Information - Here displays the information about the host. It can be IP or MAC.  
Modify - To modify or delete an existing entry.  
To add a new entry, please follow the steps below.  
1. Click the Add New… button.  
2. In the Mode field, select IP Address or MAC Address.  
z
If you select IP Address, the screen shown is Figure 4-61.  
1) In Host Description field, create a unique description for the host (e.g. Host_1).  
- 81 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
2) In LAN IP Address field, enter the IP address.  
z
If you select MAC Address, the screen shown is Figure 4-62.  
1) In Host Description field, create a unique description for the host (e.g. Host_1).  
2) In MAC Address field, enter the MAC address.  
3. Click the Save button to complete the settings.  
Click the Delete All button to delete all the entries in the table.  
Click the Next button to go to the next page, or click the Previous button return to the  
previous page.  
Figure 4-61 Add or Modify a Host Entry  
Figure 4-62 Add or Modify a Host Entry  
For example: If you desire to restrict the internet activities of host with MAC address  
00-11-22-33-44-AA, you should first follow the settings below:  
1. Click Add New... button in Figure 4-60 to enter the Add or Modify a Host Entry page.  
2. In Mode field, select MAC Address from the drop-down list.  
3. In Host Description field, create a unique description for the host (e.g. Host_1).  
4. In MAC Address field, enter 00-11-22-33-44-AA.  
5. Click Save to complete the settings.  
Then you will go back to the Host Settings page and see the following list.  
- 82 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure 4-63 Host Settings  
4.13.3 Target  
Choose menu “Access Control Target”, you can view and set a Target list in the screen as  
shown in Figure 4-64. The target list is necessary for the Access Restriction Rule.  
Figure 4-64 Target Settings  
¾
Target Description - Here displays the description about the target and this description is  
unique.  
¾
¾
Information - The target can be IP address, port, or domain name.  
Modify - To modify or delete an existing entry.  
To add a new entry, please follow the steps below.  
1. Click the Add New… button.  
2. In Mode field, select IP Address or Domain Name.  
z
If you select IP Address, the screen shown is Figure 4-65.  
1) In Target Description field, create a unique description for the target (e.g.  
Target_1).  
2) In IP Address field, enter the IP address of the target.  
3) Select a common service from Common Service Port drop-down list, so that the  
Target Port will be automatically filled. If the Common Service Port drop-down list  
doesn’t have the service you want, specify the Target Port manually.  
4) In Protocol field, select TCP, UDP, ICMP or ALL.  
z
If you select Domain Name, the screen shown is Figure 4-66.  
1) In Target Description field, create a unique description for the target (e.g.  
Target_1).  
- 83 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
2) In Domain Name field, enter the domain name, either the full name or the keywords  
(for example Google) in the blank. Any domain name with keywords in it  
(e.g.www.google.com) will be blocked or allowed. You can enter 4 domain names.  
3. Click the Save button.  
Click the Delete All button to delete all the entries in the table.  
Click the Next button to go to the next page, or click the Previous button return to the  
previous page.  
Figure 4-65 Add or Modify an Access Target Entry  
Figure 4-66 Add or Modify an Access Target Entry  
For example: If you desire to restrict the internet activities of host with MAC address  
00-11-22-33-44-AA in the LAN to access www.google.com only, you should first follow the  
settings below:  
1. Click Add New… button in Figure 4-64 to enter the Add or Modify an Access Target Entry  
page.  
2. In Mode field, select Domain Name from the drop-down list.  
3. In Target Description field, create a unique description for the target (e.g. Target_1).  
4. In Domain Name field, enter www.google.com.  
5. Click Save to complete the settings.  
- 84 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Then you will go back to the Target Settings page and see the following list,  
Figure 4-67 Target Settings  
4.13.4 Schedule  
Choose menu “Access Control Schedule”, you can view and set a Schedule list in the next  
screen as shown in Figure 4-68. The Schedule list is necessary for the Access Restriction Rule.  
Figure 4-68 Schedule Settings  
¾
Schedule Description - Here displays the description of the schedule and this description is  
unique.  
¾
¾
¾
Day - Here displays the day(s) in a week.  
Time - Here displays the time period in a day.  
Modify - Here you can edit or delete an existing schedule.  
To add a new schedule, follow the steps below.  
1. Click Add New... button shown in Figure 4-68 and the next screen will pop-up as shown in  
2. In Schedule Description field, create a unique description for the schedule (e.g.  
Schedule_1).  
3. In Day field, select the day or days you need.  
4. In Time field, you can select all day-24 hours or you may enter the Start Time and Stop Time  
in the corresponding field.  
5. Click Save to complete the settings.  
Click the Delete All button to delete all the entries in the table.  
- 85 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Click the Next button to go to the next page, or click the Previous button return to the previous  
page.  
Figure 4-69 Advanced Schedule Settings  
For example: If you desire to restrict the internet activities of host with MAC address  
00-11-22-33-44-AA to access www.google.com only from 18:00 to 20:00 on Saturday and  
Sunday, you should first follow the settings below:  
1. Click Add New... button shown in Figure 4-68 to enter the Advanced Schedule Settings  
page.  
2. In Schedule Description field, create a unique description for the schedule (e.g.  
Schedule_1).  
3. In Day field, check the Select Days radio button and then select Sat and Sun.  
4. In Time field, enter 1800 in Start Time field and 2000 in Stop Time field.  
5. Click Save to complete the settings.  
Then you will go back to the Schedule Settings page and see the following list.  
Figure 4-70 Schedule Settings  
- 86 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
4.14 Advanced Routing  
Figure 4-71 The Advanced Routing Menu  
There are two submenus under the Network menu (shown in Figure 4-71): Static Routing List  
and System Routing Table. Click any of them, and you will be able to configure the  
corresponding function.  
4.14.1 Static Routing List  
Choose menu “Static Routing”, and you can configure the static route in the next screen, shown  
in Figure 4-72. A static route is a pre-determined path that network information must travel to  
reach a specific host or network.  
Figure 4-72 Static Routing  
To add static routing entries, follow the steps below.  
Figure 4-73 Add or Modify a Static Route Entry  
2. Enter the following data.  
¾ Destination Network - The Destination IP Address is the address of the network or host  
that you want to assign to a static route.  
- 87 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
¾
Subnet Mask - The Subnet Mask determines which portion of an IP Address is the  
network portion, and which portion is the host portion.  
¾ Default Gateway - This is the IP Address of the gateway device that allows for contact  
between the Router and the network or host.  
3. Select Enabled or Disabled for this entry on the Status drop-down list.  
4. Click the Save button to make the entry take effect.  
Click the Delete button to delete the entry.  
Click the Enable All button to enable all the entries.  
Click the Disable All button to disable all the entries.  
Click the Delete All button to delete all the entries.  
Click the Previous button to view the information in the previous screen, click the Next  
button to view the information in the next screen.  
4.14.2 System Routing Table  
Choose menu “Advanced Routing System Routing Table”, and you can views all of the  
valid route entries in use. The Destination IP address, Subnet Mask, Gateway, and Interface will  
be displayed for each entry.  
Figure 4-74 Routing Table  
¾
¾
¾
¾
Destination Network - The Destination IP Address is the address of the network or host to  
which the static route is assigned.  
Subnet Mask - The Subnet Mask determines which portion of an IP address is the network  
portion, and which portion is the host portion.  
Gateway - This is the IP address of the gateway device that allows for contact between the  
Router and the network or host.  
Interface - This interface tells you whether the Destination IP Address is on the LAN &  
WLAN (internal wired and wireless networks), the WAN (Internet).  
Click the Refresh button to refresh the data displayed.  
- 88 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
4.15Bandwidth Control  
Figure 4-75 The Bandwidth Control menu  
There are two submenus under the Bandwidth Control menu as shown in Figure 4-75. Click any  
of them, and you will be able to configure the corresponding function. The detailed explanations  
for each submenu are provided below.  
4.15.1 Control Settings  
Choose menu “Bandwidth Control Control Settings”, you can configure the Egress  
Bandwidth and Ingress Bandwidth in the next screen. Their values you configure should be less  
than 100000Kbps. For optimal control of the bandwidth, please select the right Line Type and ask  
your ISP for the total bandwidth of the egress and ingress.  
Figure 4-76 Bandwidth Control Settings  
¾
¾
Enable Bandwidth Control - Check this box so that the Bandwidth Control settings can take  
effect.  
Line Type - Select the right type for you network connection. If you don’t know how to choose,  
please ask your ISP for the information.  
¾
¾
Egress Bandwidth - The upload speed through the WAN port.  
Ingress Bandwidth - The download speed through the WAN port.  
4.15.2 Rule List  
Choose menu “Bandwidth Control Rule List”, you can view and configure the Bandwidth  
Control rules in the screen below.  
- 89 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure 4-77 Bandwidth Control Rule List  
¾
Description - This is the information about the rules such as address range.  
¾
Egress Bandwidth - This field displays the max and mix upload bandwidth through the WAN  
port, the default is 0.  
¾
Ingress Bandwidth - This field displays the max and mix download bandwidth through the  
WAN port, the default is 0.  
¾
¾
Enable - This displays the status of the rule.  
Modify - Click Modify to edit the rule. Click Delete to delete the rule.  
To add/modify a Bandwidth Control rule, follow the steps below.  
Step 2: Enter the information like the screen shown below.  
Figure 4-78 Bandwidth Control Rule Settings  
¾ Enable - Enable or disable the rule.  
¾ IP Range - Interior PC address range. If both are blank (or 0.0.0.0), the domain is no  
effective.  
¾ Port Range - The port range which the Interior PC access the outside PC. If all are blank  
(or 0), the domain is no effective.  
¾ Protocol - Transport layer protocol, here there are All, TCP, UDP.  
- 90 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
¾ Egress Bandwidth - The max and the min upload speed which through the WAN port,  
default number is 0.  
¾ Ingress Bandwidth - The max and the min download speed through the WAN port,  
default number is 0.  
Step 3: Click the Save button.  
4.16 IP & MAC Binding  
Figure 4-79 The IP & MAC Binding menu  
There are two submenus under the IP & MAC Binding menu: Binding Setting and ARP List.  
Click any of them, and you will be able to scan or configure the corresponding function. The  
detailed explanations for each submenu are provided below.  
4.16.1 Binding Setting  
This page displays the IP & MAC Binding Setting table; you can operate it in accord with your  
desire.  
Figure 4-80 IP & MAC Binding Setting  
¾
¾
¾
¾
MAC Address - The MAC address of the controlled computer in the LAN.  
IP Address - The assigned IP address of the controlled computer in the LAN.  
Bind - Whether or not enable the ARP binding.  
Modify - Edit or delete item.  
- 91 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
When you want to add or modify an IP & MAC Binding entry, you can click the Add New button  
or Modify button, and then you will go to the next page. This page is used for adding or  
modifying an IP & MAC Binding entry.  
Figure 4-81 IP & MAC Binding Setting (Add & Modify)  
To add IP & MAC Binding entries:  
1. Click the Add New.. button.  
2. Enter the MAC Address and IP Address.  
3. Select the Bind checkbox.  
4. Click the Save button to save it.  
To modify or delete an existing entry:  
1. Find the desired entry in the table.  
2. Click Modify or Delete as desired on the Modify column.  
To find an existing entry:  
1. Click the Find button (shown in Figure 4-80).  
2. Enter the MAC Address or IP Address.  
3. Enter the Find button in the next page (shown in Figure 4-82).  
Figure 4-82 Find IP & MAC Binding Entry  
- 92 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Click the Enable All button to make all entries enabled.  
Click the Delete All button to delete all entries.  
4.16.2 ARP List  
To manage the computer, you could observe the computers in the LAN by checking the  
relationship of MAC address and IP address on the ARP list, and you could configure the items on  
the ARP list also. This page displays the ARP List; it shows all the existing IP & MAC Binding  
entries.  
Figure 4-83 ARP List  
¾
¾
¾
¾
¾
¾
MAC Address - The MAC address of the controlled computer in the LAN.  
IP Address - The assigned IP address of the controlled computer in the LAN.  
Status - Enabled or Disabled of the MAC address and IP address binding.  
Configure - Load or delete item.  
Load - Load the item to the IP & MAC Binding list.  
Delete - Delete the item.  
Click the Bind All button to bind all the current items, available after enable.  
Click the Load All button to load all items to the IP & MAC Binding list.  
Click the Refresh button to refresh all items.  
Note:  
)
An item could not be loaded to the IP & MAC Binding list if the IP address of the item has been  
loaded before. Error warning will prompt as well. Likewise, "Load All" only loads the items without  
interference to the IP & MAC Binding list.  
4.17 Dynamic DNS  
The Router offers the DDNS (Dynamic Domain Name System) feature, which allows the hosting  
of a website, FTP server, or e-mail server with a fixed domain name (named by yourself) and a  
- 93 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
dynamic IP address, and then your friends can connect to your server by entering your domain  
name no matter what your IP address is. Before using this feature, you need to sign up for DDNS  
service providers such as www.no-ip.com, www.comexe.cn, or www.dyndns.org. The Dynamic  
DNS client service provider will give you a password or key.  
4.17.1 No-IP DDNS  
If the dynamic DNS Service Provider you select is www.no-ip.com, the page will appear as  
shown in Figure 4-84.  
Figure 4-84 No-IP DDNS Settings  
To set up for DDNS, follow these instructions:  
1. Type the User Name for your DDNS account.  
2. Type the Password for your DDNS account.  
3. Type the Domain Name you received from dynamic DNS service provider.  
4. Click the Login button to log in the DDNS service.  
Connection Status - The status of the DDNS service connection is displayed here.  
Click Logout to log out the DDNS service.  
Note:  
)
If you want to login again with another account after a successful login, please click the Logout  
button, then input your new username and password and click the Login button.  
4.17.2 Comexe.cn DDNS  
If the dynamic DNS Service Provider you select is www.comexe.cn, the page will appear as  
shown in Figure 4-85.  
- 94 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure 4-85 Comexe.cn DDNS Settings  
To set up for DDNS, follow these instructions:  
1. Type the Domain Name received from your dynamic DNS service provider.  
2. Type the User Name for your DDNS account.  
3. Type the Password for your DDNS account.  
4. Click the Login button to log in to the DDNS service.  
Connection Status -The status of the DDNS service connection is displayed here.  
Click Logout to log out of the DDNS service.  
4.17.3 Dyndns org DDNS  
If the dynamic DNS Service Provider you select is www.dyndns.org, the page will appear as  
shown in Figure 4-86.  
- 95 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure 4-86 Dyndns.org DDNS Settings  
To set up for DDNS, follow these instructions:  
1. Type the User Name for your DDNS account.  
2. Type the Password for your DDNS account.  
3. Type the Domain Name you received from dynamic DNS service provider here.  
4. Click the Login button to log in to the DDNS service.  
Connection Status -The status of the DDNS service connection is displayed here.  
Click Logout to logout of the DDNS service.  
4.18 System Tools  
Figure 4-87 The System Tools menu  
There are nine submenus under the System Tools menu: Time Settings, Diagnostic, Firmware  
Upgrade, Factory Defaults, Backup and Restore, Reboot, Password, System Log and  
- 96 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Statistics. Click any of them, and you will be able to configure the corresponding function. The  
detailed explanations for each submenu are provided below.  
4.18.1 Time Settings  
You can set time manually or get GMT from the Internet for the router on this page:  
Figure 4-88 Time Settings  
¾
¾
¾
Time Zone - Select your local time zone from this pull-down list.  
Date - Enter your local date in MM/DD/YY into the right blanks.  
Time - Enter your local time in HH/MM/SS into the right blanks.  
To set time manually, follow the steps below:  
1. Select your local time zone.  
2. Enter the Date in Month/Day/Year format.  
3. Enter the Time in Hour/Minute/Second format.  
4. Click Save.  
For automatic time synchronization:  
1. Enter the address of the NTP Server 1 or NTP Server 2.  
2. Click the Get GMT button to get GMT time from Internet if you have connected to Internet.  
Note:  
)
This setting will be used for some time-based functions such as firewall. You must specify your  
time zone once you login to the router successfully, if not, the time limited on these functions will  
not take effect.  
- 97 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
¾
¾
The time will be lost if the router is turned off.  
The router will obtain GMT automatically from Internet if it has already connected to Internet.  
4.18.2 Diagnostic  
Choose menu “System Tools Diagnostic”, you can transact Ping or Traceroute function to  
check connectivity of your network in the following screen.  
Figure 4-89 Diagnostic Tools  
¾
Diagnostic Tool - Check the radio button to select one diagnostic too.  
Ping - This diagnostic tool troubleshoots connectivity, reachability, and name resolution to  
a given host or gateway.  
Traceroute - This diagnostic tool tests the performance of a connection.  
)
Note:  
You can use ping/traceroute to test both numeric IP address or domain name. If  
pinging/tracerouting the IP address is successful, but pinging/tracerouting the domain name is not,  
you might have a name resolution problem. In this case, ensure that the domain name you are  
specifying can be resolved by using Domain Name System (DNS) queries.  
¾
IP Address/Domain Name - Type the destination IP address (such as 202.108.22.5) or  
Domain name (such as www.baidu.com).  
¾
Pings Count - The number of Ping packets for a Ping connection.  
- 98 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Ping Packet Size - The size of Ping packet.  
¾
¾
Ping Timeout - Set the waiting time for the reply of each Ping packet. If there is no reply in  
the specified time, the connection is overtime.  
¾
Traceroute Max TTL - The max number of hops for a Traceroute connection.  
Click Start to check the connectivity of the Internet.  
The Diagnostic Results page displays the result of diagnosis.  
If the result is similar to the following screen, the connectivity of the Internet is fine.  
Figure 4-90 Diagnostic Results  
Note:  
)
Only one user can use this tool at one time. "Ping Count", "Ping Packet Size" and "Ping Timeout"  
are Ping Parameters. "Traceroute Max TTL" is Traceroute Parameter.  
4.18.3 Firmware Upgrade  
The page allows you to upgrade the latest version firmware to keep your router up-to-date.  
Figure 4-91 Firmware Upgrade  
New firmware is posted at www.tp-link.com and can be downloaded for free. If the router is not  
experiencing difficulties, there is no need to upgrade firmware, unless the new firmware supports  
a new feature you need.  
- 99 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Note:  
)
1. When you upgrade the router's firmware, you will lose current configuration settings, so make  
sure you backup the router’s settings before you upgrade its firmware.  
2. Make sure that your computer is connected to the Internet through the cable when you  
upgrade the firmware. To upgrade through wireless connection is not allowed.  
3. Set your IP address as static IP before upgrading.  
To upgrade the router's firmware, follow these instructions:  
1. Download the latest firmware upgrade file from our website http://www.tp-link.com.  
2. Enter or select the path name where you save the downloaded file on the computer into the  
File blank.  
3. Click the Upgrade button.  
¾
¾
Firmware Version - Displays the current firmware version.  
Hardware Version - Displays the current hardware version. The hardware version of the  
upgrade file must accord with the current hardware version.  
Note:  
)
The firmware version must correspond to the hardware. The upgrade process takes a few minutes  
and the Router will restart automatically when the upgrade is completed. It is important to keep  
power on during the entire process. Loss of power during the upgrade could damage the Router.  
4.18.4 Factory Defaults  
This page allows you to restore the factory default settings for the router.  
Figure 4-92 Restore Factory Default  
Click the Restore button to reset all configuration settings to their default values.  
¾
¾
¾
The default User Name: admin  
The default Password: admin  
The default access: tplinklogin.net  
Note:  
)
Any settings you have saved will be lost when the default settings are restored.  
- 100 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
4.18.5 Backup & Restore  
This page allows you to save current configuration of router as backup or restore the configuration  
file you saved before.  
Figure 4-93 Backup & Restore Configuration  
¾
¾
Click the Backup button to save all configuration settings as a backup file in your local  
computer.  
To restore the router's configuration, follow these instructions:  
Click the Browse button to select the backup file which you want to restore.  
Click the Restore button.  
Note:  
)
The current configuration will be covered with the uploading configuration file. The restoration  
process lasts for 20 seconds and the router will restart automatically. Keep the router on during the  
restoring process to prevent any damage.  
4.18.6 Reboot  
This page allows you to reboot the router.  
Figure 4-94 Reboot the router  
Click the Reboot button to reboot the router.  
Some settings of the router will take effect only after rebooting, which include:  
¾
¾
¾
¾
Change LAN IP Address. (System will reboot automatically)  
MAC Clone (system will reboot automatically)  
DHCP service function.  
Static address assignment of DHCP server.  
- 101 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Web Service Port of the router.  
¾
¾
¾
Upgrade the firmware of the router (system will reboot automatically).  
Restore the router's settings to factory default (system will reboot automatically).  
4.18.7 Password  
This page allows you to change the factory default user name and password of the router.  
Figure 4-95 Password  
It is recommended strongly that you change the factory default user name and password of the  
router. All users who try to access the router's Web-based utility or Quick Setup will be prompted  
Note:  
)
The new user name and password must not exceed 14 characters in length and must not include  
any spaces. Enter the new Password twice to confirm it.  
Click the  
button when finished.  
Save  
Click the Clear All button to clear all.  
4.18.8 System Log  
This page allows you to query the logs of the router.  
- 102 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure 4-96 System Log  
¾
¾
¾
Refresh - Refresh the page to show the latest log list.  
Save Log - Click to save all the logs in a txt file.  
Mail Log - Click to send an email of current logs manually according to the address and  
validation information set in Mail Settings. The result will be shown in the later log soon.  
¾
Clear Log - All the logs will be deleted from this device permanently, not just from the page.  
4.18.9 Statistics  
The Statistics page displays the network traffic of each PC in LAN, including total traffic and traffic  
of the last Packets Statistic interval seconds.  
- 103 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure 4-97 Statistics  
¾
Current Statistics Status - Enable or Disable. The default value is disabled. To enable, click  
the Enable button. If disabled, the function of DoS protection in Security settings will be  
ineffective.  
¾
¾
Packets Statistics Interval - The default value is 10. Select a value between 5 and 60  
seconds in the pull-down list. The Packets Statistic interval indicates the time section of the  
packets statistic.  
Sorted Rules - Here displays sort as desired.  
Statistics Table:  
IP Address  
Packets  
The IP Address displayed with statistics  
The total amount of packets received and transmitted by the  
router.  
Total  
Bytes  
The total amount of bytes received and transmitted by the router.  
The total amount of packets received and transmitted in the last  
Packets Statistic interval seconds.  
Packets  
The total amount of bytes received and transmitted in the last  
Packets Statistic interval seconds.  
Bytes  
ICMP Tx  
The total amount of the ICMP packets transmitted to WAN in the  
last Packets Statistic interval seconds.  
Current  
The total amount of the UDP packets transmitted to WAN in the  
last Packets Statistic interval seconds.  
UDP Tx  
The total amount of the TCP SYN packets transmitted to WAN in  
the last Packets Statistic interval seconds.  
TCP SYN Tx  
Click the Save button to save the Packets Statistic interval value.  
Click the Auto-refresh checkbox to refresh automatically.  
Click the Refresh button to refresh immediately.  
- 104 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Chapter 5. Configuration for Access Point Mode  
This chapter will show each Web page's key functions and the configuration way for Access Point  
Mode of TL-WR710N.  
5.1 Login  
After your successful login, you can configure and manage the device. There are main menus on  
the left of the web-based utility. Submenus will be available after you click one of the main menus.  
On the right, there are the corresponding explanations and instructions.  
Figure 5-1  
The detailed explanations for each Web page’s key function are listed below.  
5.2 Status  
The Status page provides the current status information about the Router on Access Point Mode.  
All information is read-only.  
- 105 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure 5-2 Status  
¾
¾
¾
Firmware Version - The version information of the Router’s firmware.  
Hardware Version - The version information of the Router’s hardware.  
Wired - This field displays the current settings or information for the LAN, you can configure  
them in the Network > LAN page.  
MAC address - The physical address of the Router, as seen from the LAN.  
IP address - The LAN IP address of the Router.  
Subnet Mask - The subnet mask associated with LAN IP address.  
¾
Wireless - This field displays basic information or status for wireless function, you can  
configure them in the Wireless > Wireless Settings page.  
Working Mode - The current wireless working mode in use.  
Wireless Network Name - The SSID of the AP.  
Channel - The current wireless channel in use.  
Mode - The current wireless mode which the Router works on.  
- 106 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Channel Width - The current wireless channel width in use.  
MAC Address - The physical address of the Router, as seen from the WLAN.  
Traffic Statistics - The Router’s traffic statistics.  
¾
Received (Bytes) - Traffic that counted in bytes has been received out from the WAN port.  
Received (Packets) - Traffic that counted in packets has been received out from the WAN  
port.  
Sent (Bytes) - Traffic that counted in bytes has been sent out from the WAN port.  
Sent (Packets) - Traffic that counted in packets has been sent out from the WAN port.  
System Up Time - The length of the time since the Router was last powered on or reset.  
¾
Click the Refresh button to get the latest status and settings of the Router.  
5.3 Quick Setup  
5.4 WPS  
WPS (Wi-Fi Protected Setup) can help you to quickly and securely connect to a network. This  
section will guide you to add a new wireless device to an existing network quickly by function. The  
WPS function is only available when the Operation Mode is set to Access Point. Select menu  
WPS”, you will see the next screen shown in Figure 5-3.  
Figure 5-3 WPS  
¾
¾
WPS Status - To enable or disable the WPS function here.  
Current PIN - The current value of the device's PIN is displayed here. The default PIN of the  
device can be found in the label or User Guide.  
¾
¾
Restore PIN - Restore the PIN of the device to its default.  
Gen New PIN - Click this button, and then you can get a new random value for the device's  
PIN. You can ensure the network security by generating a new PIN.  
- 107 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
¾
¾
Disable PIN of this Device - WPS external registrar of entering the device’s PIN can be  
disabled or enabled manually. If the device receives multiple failed attempts to authenticate  
an external Registrar, this function will be disabled automatically.  
Add Device - You can add a new device to the existing network manually by clicking this  
button.  
To add a new device:  
If the wireless adapter supports Wi-Fi Protected Setup (WPS), you can establish a wireless  
connection between wireless adapter and device using either Push Button Configuration (PBC)  
method or PIN method.  
Note:  
)
To build a successful connection by WPS, you should also do the corresponding configuration of  
the new device for WPS function meanwhile.  
For the configuration of the new device, here takes the Wireless Adapter of our company for  
example.  
II. By PBC  
If the wireless adapter supports Wi-Fi Protected Setup and the Push Button Configuration (PBC)  
method, you can add it to the network by PBC with the following two methods.  
Method One:  
Step 1: Keep the WPS Status as Enabled and click the Add Device button in Figure 5-3, then  
the following screen will appear.  
Figure 5-4 Add A New Device  
Step 2: Choose “Press the button of the new device in two minutes” and click Connect.  
Step 3: For the configuration of the wireless adapter, please choose “Push the button on my  
access point or wireless router” in the configuration utility of the WPS as below, and  
click Connect.  
- 108 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
The WPS Configuration Screen of Wireless Adapter  
Step 4: Wait for a while until the next screen appears. Click OK to complete the WPS  
configuration.  
The WPS Configuration Screen of Wireless Adapter  
Method Two: Enter the PIN into my AP  
Step 1: For the configuration of the wireless adapter, please choose “Enter the PIN of this  
device into my access point or wireless router” in the configuration utility of the WPS  
as below, and click Connect.  
- 109 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
The WPS Configuration Screen of Wireless Adapter  
Note:  
)
In this example, the default PIN code of this adapter is 16952898 as the above figure shown.  
Step 2: Keep the WPS Status as Enabled and click the Add Device button in Figure 5-3.  
Step 3: Choose “Enter the new device's PIN” and enter the PIN code take 16952898 for  
exampleof the wireless adapter in the field after PIN as shown in the figure below.  
Then click Connect.  
Figure 5-5 Add A New Device  
Method Three: Enter the PIN from my AP  
Step 1: Get the Current PIN code of the AP in Figure 5-3 (each AP has its unique PIN code. Here  
takes the PIN code 12345670 of this AP for example).  
- 110 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Step 2: For the configuration of the wireless adapter, please choose “Enter the PIN of my  
access point or wireless router” in the configuration utility of the WPS as below, and  
enter the PIN code of the AP into the field after “Access Point PIN”. Then click Connect.  
The WPS Configuration Screen of Wireless Adapter  
Note:  
)
The default PIN code of the AP can be found in its label or the WPS configuration screen as  
You will see the following screen when the new device has successfully connected to the network.  
Figure 5-6  
Note:  
)
1) The WPS LED on the AP will light green for five minutes if the device has been successfully  
added to the network.  
2) The WPS function cannot be configured if the Wireless function of the AP is disabled. Please  
make sure the Wireless function is enabled before configuring the WPS.  
- 111 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
5.5 Working Mode  
The Router supports five operation mode types: Wireless Router, Access Point, Repeater,  
Client and Wireless Client Router. Please select one you want. Click Save to save your choice,  
which is shown as Figure 5-7.  
Figure 5-7 Wireless Working Mode Settings  
¾
Wireless Router - The wireless Router Mode. In this mode, the device enables multi-user to  
share Internet via DSL/Cable Modem. The only wired port works as WAN.  
¾
¾
¾
Access Point - The wireless access point mode.  
Repeater - The wireless Repeater Mode. It could extend the range of wireless network.  
Client - The Client Mode. The computer connected by Ethernet could get access to an AP by  
Client mode.  
¾
WISP Client Router - In this mode, the device enables multiple users to share Internet  
connection from WISP.  
5.6 Network  
Figure 5-8 the Network menu  
There is only one submenu under the Network menu (shown in Figure 5-8): LAN.  
5.6.1 LAN  
Choose menu “Network LAN”, and then you can configure the IP parameters of the LAN on  
the screen as below.  
- 112 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure 5-9 LAN  
¾
¾
¾
¾
¾
MAC Address - The physical address of the LAN ports, as seen from the LAN. The value can  
not be changed.  
Type - Choosing Smart IP (DHCP) to get IP address from DHCP server, or choosing static IP  
to config IP address manually.  
IP Address - Enter the IP address of your system in dotted-decimal notation (factory default -  
192.168.0.254).  
Subnet Mask - An address code that determines the size of the network. Normally  
255.255.255.0 is used as the subnet mask.  
IGMP Proxy - The Internet Group Management Protocol(IGMP) feature allows your devices in  
LAN can watch TV.  
Note:  
)
1. If you change the IP Address of LAN, you must use the new IP Address to login to the Router.  
2. If the new LAN IP Address you set is not in the same subnet with the previous one, the IP  
Address pool in the DHCP server will be configured automaticallywhile the Virtual Server and  
DMZ Host will not take effect until they are re-configured.  
3. When you choose the Smart IP(DHCP) mode, the DHCP Server function will be disabled.  
5.7 Wireless  
Figure 5-10 Wireless menu  
- 113 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
There are five submenus under the Wireless menu (shown in Figure 5-10): Wireless Settings,  
Wireless Security, Wireless MAC Filtering, Wireless Advanced and Wireless Statistics. Click  
any of them, and you will be able to configure the corresponding function.  
5.7.1 Wireless Settings  
Choose menu “Wireless Wireless Settings”, and then you can configure the basic settings  
for the wireless network on this page.  
Figure 5-11 Wireless Settings - AP  
¾
Wireless Network Name - Enter a string of up to 32 characters. The same name of SSID  
(Service Set Identification) must be assigned to all wireless devices in your network. The  
default SSID is set to be TP-LINK_XXXXXX (XXXXXX indicates the last unique six numbers  
of each Router’s MAC address). But it is recommended strongly that you change your  
networks name (SSID) to a different value. This value is case-sensitive. For example, TEST  
is NOT the same as test.  
¾
Region - Select your region from the pull-down list. This field specifies the region where the  
wireless function of the Router can be used. It may be illegal to use the wireless function of  
the Router in a region other than one of those specified in this field. If your country or region  
is not listed, please contact your local government agency for assistance.  
¾
¾
Channel - This field determines which operating frequency will be used. The default channel  
is set to Auto. It is not necessary to change the wireless channel unless you notice  
interference problems with another nearby access point.  
Mode - Select the desired mode. The default setting is 11bgn mixed.  
11bg mixed - Select if you are using both 802.11b and 802.11g wireless clients.  
11bgn mixed - Select if you are using a mix of 802.11b, 11g, and 11n wireless clients.  
- 114 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
When 11bg mixed mode is selected, only 11bg mixed wireless stations can connect to the  
Router. It is strongly recommended that you set the Mode to 11bgn mixed, and all of  
802.11b/g/n wireless stations can connect to the Router.  
Note:  
)
If 11bg mixed mode is selected in the Mode field, the Channel Width selecting field will turn  
grey and the value will become 20M, which is unable to be changed.  
¾
¾
Channel Width - Select any channel width from the pull-down list. The default setting is  
automatic, which can automatically adjust the channel width for your clients.  
Enable Wireless Radio - The wireless radio of the Router can be enabled or disabled to  
allow wireless stations access. If enabled, the wireless stations will be able to access the  
Router. Otherwise, wireless stations will not be able to access the Router.  
¾
Enable SSID Broadcast - If you select the Enable SSID Broadcast checkbox, the wireless  
router will broadcast its name (SSID) on the air.  
Be sure to click the Save button to save your settings on this page.  
Note:  
)
1. The operating distance or range of your wireless connection varies significantly based on the  
physical placement of the Router. For best results, place your Router.  
z
z
z
Near the center of the area in which your wireless stations will operate.  
In an elevated location such as a high shelf.  
Away from the potential sources of interference, such as PCs, microwaves, and cordless  
phones.  
z
Away from large metal surfaces.  
2. Failure to follow these guidelines can result in significant performance degradation or inability  
to wirelessly connect to the Router.  
5.7.2 Wireless Security  
Choose menu “Wireless Wireless Security”, and then you can configure the security  
settings of your wireless network.  
There are three wireless security modes supported by the Router: WPA/WPA2-Personal,  
WPA/WPA2-Enterprise and WEP (Wired Equivalent Privacy).  
- 115 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure 5-12 Wireless Security  
¾
¾
Disable Security - The wireless security function can be enabled or disabled. If disabled, the  
wireless stations will be able to connect the Router without encryption. But it’s strongly  
recommended to choose one of the following modes to enable security.  
WPA-PSK/WPA2-Personal - It’s the WPA/WPA2 authentication type based on pre-shared  
passphrase.  
Version - you can choose the version of the WPA-PSK security on the drop-down list. The  
default setting is Automatic, which can select WPA-PSK (Pre-shared key of WPA) or  
WPA2-PSK (Pre-shared key of WPA) automatically based on the wireless station's  
capability and request.  
Encryption - When WPA-PSK or WPA is set as the Authentication Type, you can select  
either Automatic, or TKIP or AES as Encryption.  
Note:  
)
If you check the WPA/WPA2-Personal radio button and choose TKIP encryption, you will find  
- 116 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure 5-13  
¾
WPA /WPA2-Enterprise - It’s based on Radius Server.  
Version - you can choose the version of the WPA security from the pull-down list. The  
default setting is Automatic, which can select WPA (Wi-Fi Protected Access) or WPA2  
(WPA version 2) automatically based on the wireless station's capability and request.  
Encryption - You can select Automatic, TKIP or AES.  
Radius Server IP - Enter the IP address of the Radius server.  
Radius Port - Enter the port that Radius server used.  
Radius Password - Enter the password for the Radius server.  
Group Key Update Period - Specify the group key update interval in seconds. The value  
should be 30 or above. Enter 0 to disable the update.  
¾
WEP - It is based on the IEEE 802.11 standard.  
Type - you can choose the type for the WEP security on the pull-down list. The default  
setting is Automatic, which can select Shared Key or Open System authentication type  
automatically based on the wireless station's capability and request.  
WEP Key Format - Hexadecimal and ASCII formats are provided here. Hexadecimal  
format stands for any combination of hexadecimal digits (0-9, a-f, A-F) in the specified  
length. ASCII format stands for any combination of keyboard characters in the specified  
length.  
WEP Key (Password) - Select which of the four keys will be used and enter the matching  
WEP key that you create. Make sure these values are identical on all wireless stations in  
your network.  
Key Type - You can select the WEP key length (64-bit, or 128-bit, or 152-bit.) for  
encryption. "Disabled" means this WEP key entry is invalid.  
64-bit - You can enter 10 hexadecimal digits (any combination of 0-9, a-f, A-F, zero key is  
not promoted) or 5 ASCII characters.  
128-bit - You can enter 26 hexadecimal digits (any combination of 0-9, a-f, A-F, zero key is  
not promoted) or 13 ASCII characters.  
- 117 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
152-bit - You can enter 32 hexadecimal digits (any combination of 0-9, a-f, A-F, zero key is  
not promoted) or 16 ASCII characters.  
Note:  
)
If you do not set the key, the wireless security function is still disabled even if you have selected  
Shared Key as Authentication Type.  
5.7.3 Wireless MAC Filtering  
Choose menu “Wireless Wireless MAC Filtering”, and then you can control the wireless  
access by configuring the Wireless MAC Filtering function, as shown in Figure 5-14.  
Figure 5-14 Wireless MAC Filtering  
To filter wireless users by MAC Address, click Enabled. The default setting is Disabled.  
¾
¾
¾
MAC Address - The wireless station's MAC address that you want to access.  
Status - The status of this entry, either Enabled or Disabled.  
Description - A simple description of the wireless station.  
To Add a Wireless MAC Address filtering entry, click the Add New… button. The "Add or Modify  
Wireless MAC Address Filtering entry" page will appear, shown in Figure 5-15:  
Figure 5-15 Add or Modify Wireless MAC Address Filtering entry  
- 118 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
To add or modify a MAC Address Filtering entry, follow these instructions:  
1. Enter the appropriate MAC Address into the MAC Address field. The format of the MAC  
Address is XX-XX-XX-XX-XX-XX (X is any hexadecimal digit). For example:  
00-0A-EB-B0-00-0B.  
2. Give a simple description for the wireless station in the Description field. For example:  
Wireless station A.  
3. Select Enabled or Disabled for this entry on the Status pull-down list.  
4. Click the Save button to save this entry.  
To modify or delete an existing entry:  
1. Click the Modify in the entry you want to modify. If you want to delete the entry, click the  
Delete.  
2. Modify the information.  
3. Click the Save button.  
Click the Enable All button to make all entries enabled  
Click the Disable All button to make all entries disabled.  
Click the Delete All button to delete all entries.  
Click the Next button to go to the next page.  
Click the Previous button to return to the previous page.  
For example: If you desire that the wireless station A with MAC address 00-0A-EB-B0-00-0B and  
the wireless station B with MAC address 00-0A-EB-00-07-5F are able to access the Router, but all  
the other wireless stations cannot access the Router, you can configure the Wireless MAC  
Address Filtering list by following these steps:  
1. Click the Enable button to enable this function.  
2. Select the radio button “Allow the stations specified by any enabled entries in the list to  
access” for Filtering Rules.  
3. Delete all or disable all entries if there are any entries already.  
4. Click the Add New... button.  
Enter the MAC address 00-0A-EB-B0-00-0B/00-0A-EB-00-07-5F in the MAC Address field.  
Enter wireless station A/B in the Description field.  
Select Enabled in the Status pull-down list.  
Click the Save button.  
Click the Back button.  
The filtering rules that configured should be similar to the following list:  
- 119 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
5.7.4 Wireless Advanced  
Choose menu “Wireless Wireless Advanced”, and then you can configure the advanced  
settings of your wireless network.  
Figure 5-16 Wireless Advanced  
¾
¾
Transmit Power - Here you can specify the transmit power of Router. You can select High,  
Middle or Low which you would like. High is the default setting and is recommended.  
Beacon Interval - Enter a value between 20-1000 milliseconds for Beacon Interval here.  
The beacons are the packets sent by the Router to synchronize a wireless network. Beacon  
Interval value determines the time interval of the beacons. The default value is 100.  
¾
¾
¾
RTS Threshold - Here you can specify the RTS (Request to Send) Threshold. If the packet  
is larger than the specified RTS Threshold size, the Router will send RTS frames to a  
particular receiving station and negotiate the sending of a data frame. The default value is  
2346.  
Fragmentation Threshold - This value is the maximum size determining whether packets  
will be fragmented. Setting the Fragmentation Threshold too low may result in poor network  
performance because of excessive packets. 2346 is the default setting and is  
recommended.  
DTIM Interval - This value determines the interval of the Delivery Traffic Indication Message  
(DTIM). A DTIM field is a countdown field informing clients of the next window for listening to  
broadcast and multicast messages. When the Router has buffered broadcast or multicast  
- 120 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
messages for associated clients, it sends the next DTIM with a DTIM Interval value. You can  
specify the value between 1-255 Beacon Intervals. The default value is 1, which indicates  
the DTIM Interval is the same as Beacon Interval.  
¾
¾
¾
Enable WMM - WMM function can guarantee the packets with high-priority messages being  
transmitted preferentially. It is strongly recommended enabled.  
Enable Short GI - This function is recommended for it will increase the data capacity by  
reducing the guard interval time.  
Enable AP Isolation - This function isolate all connected wireless stations so that wireless  
stations cannot access each other through WLAN. This function will be disabled if  
WDS/Bridge is enabled.  
Note:  
)
If you are not familiar with the setting items in this page, it's strongly recommended to keep the  
provided default values; otherwise it may result in lower wireless network performance.  
5.7.5 Wireless Statistics  
Choose menu “Wireless Wireless Statistics”, and then you can see the MAC Address,  
Current Status, Received Packets and Sent Packets for each connected wireless station.  
Figure 5-17 Wireless Statistics  
¾
¾
MAC Address - The connected wireless station's MAC address  
Current Status - The connected wireless station's running status, one of STA-AUTH /  
STA-ASSOC / STA-JOINED / WPA / WPA-PSK / WPA2 / WPA2-PSK / AP-UP / AP-DOWN /  
Disconnected  
¾
¾
¾
Received Packets - Packets received by the station  
Sent Packets - Packets sent by the station  
Configure - The button is used for loading the item to the Wireless MAC Filtering list.  
You cannot change any of the values on this page. To update this page and to show the current  
connected wireless stations, click on the Refresh button.  
- 121 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
If the numbers of connected wireless stations go beyond one page, click the Next button to go to  
the next page and click the Previous button to return the previous page.  
Note:  
)
This page will be refreshed automatically every 5 seconds.  
5.8 DHCP  
Figure 5-18 The DHCP menu  
There are three submenus under the DHCP menu (shown in Figure 5-18), DHCP Settings,  
DHCP Client List and Address Reservation. Click any of them, and you will be able to configure  
the corresponding function.  
5.8.1 DHCP Settings  
Choose menu “DHCP DHCP Settings”, and then you can configure the DHCP Server on the  
page as shown in Figure 5-19. The Router is set up by default as a DHCP (Dynamic Host  
Configuration Protocol) server, which provides the TCP/IP configuration for all the PC(s) that are  
connected to the Router in the LAN.  
Figure 5-19 DHCP Settings  
¾
DHCP Server - Enable or Disable the DHCP server. If you disable the Server, you must  
have another DHCP server within your network or else you must configure the computer  
manually.  
- 122 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
¾
¾
¾
Start IP Address - Specify an IP address for the DHCP Server to start with when assigning  
IP addresses. 192.168.0.100 is the default start address.  
End IP Address - Specify an IP address for the DHCP Server to end with when assigning IP  
addresses. 192.168.0.199 is the default end address.  
Address Lease Time - The Address Lease Time is the amount of time a network user will  
be allowed connection to the Router with their current dynamic IP Address. Enter the  
amount of time in minutes and the user will be "leased" this dynamic IP Address. After the  
time is up, the user will be automatically assigned a new dynamic IP address. The range of  
the time is 1 ~ 2880 minutes. The default value is 120 minutes.  
¾
Default Gateway (Optional) - It is suggested to input the IP address of the LAN port of the  
Router. The default value is 192.168.0.254.  
¾
¾
Default Domain (Optional) - Input the domain name of your network.  
Primary DNS - (Optional) Input the DNS IP address provided by your ISP or consult your  
ISP.  
¾
Secondary DNS (Optional) - Input the IP address of another DNS server if your ISP  
provides two DNS servers.  
Note:  
)
1. To use the DHCP server function of the Router, you must configure all computers on the LAN  
as "Obtain an IP Address automatically".  
2. When you choose the Smart IP (DHCP) mode in Network LAN, the DHCP Server  
function will be disabled. You will see the page as below.  
Figure 5-20 DHCP Settings  
5.8.2 DHCP Client List  
Choose menu “DHCP DHCP Clients List”, and then you can view the information about the  
clients attached to the Router in the screen as shown in Figure 5-21.  
- 123 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure 5-21 DHCP Client List  
¾
¾
¾
¾
Client Name - The name of the DHCP client  
MAC Address - The MAC address of the DHCP client  
Assigned IP - The IP address that the Router has allocated to the DHCP client  
Lease Time - The time of the DHCP client leased. After the dynamic IP address has expired,  
a new dynamic IP address will be automatically assigned to the user.  
You cannot change any of the values on this page. To update this page and to show the current  
attached devices, click the Refresh button.  
5.8.3 Address Reservation  
Choose menu “DHCP Address Reservation”, and then you can view and add a reserved  
address for clients via the next screen (shown in Figure 5-22).When you specify a reserved IP  
address for a PC on the LAN, that PC will always receive the same IP address each time when it  
accesses the DHCP server. Reserved IP addresses should be assigned to the servers that  
require permanent IP settings.  
Figure 5-22 Address Reservation  
¾
¾
¾
¾
MAC Address - The MAC address of the PC for which you want to reserve an IP address.  
Reserved IP Address - The IP address reserved for the PC by the Router.  
Status - The status of this entry either Enabled or Disabled.  
Modify - To modify or delete an existing entry.  
To Reserve an IP address:  
1. Click the Add New… button. Then Figure 5-23 will pop-up.  
- 124 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
2. Enter the MAC address (in XX-XX-XX-XX-XX-XX format.) and IP address (in dotted-decimal  
notation) of the computer for which you want to reserve an IP address.  
3. Click the Save button.  
Figure 5-23 Add or Modify an Address Reservation Entry  
To modify or delete an existing entry:  
1. Click the Modify in the entry you want to modify. If you want to delete the entry, click the  
Delete.  
2. Modify the information.  
3. Click the Save button.  
Click the Enable/Disable All button to make all entries enabled/disabled  
Click the Delete All button to delete all entries.  
Click the Next button to go to the next page and Click the Previous button to return the  
previous page.  
5.9 USB Settings  
Figure 5-24 The USB Settings menu  
There are three submenus under the USB Settings menu (shown in Figure 5-24), Storage  
Sharing, Media Server and User Accounts. Click any of them, and you will be able to configure  
the corresponding functions.  
5.9.1 Storage Sharing  
Choose menu “USB SettingsStorage Sharing”, you can configure a USB disk drive attached  
to the router and view volume and share such properties as share name, capacity, used space,  
and free space on this page as shown below.  
- 125 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure 5-25 Storage Sharing  
¾
¾
Service Status - Indicates the Network Sharing service's current status. You can click the  
Start button to start the Storage Sharing service and click the Stop button to stop it.  
Volume - The volume name of the USB drive the users have access to. Volume 1-8 is  
mapping to USB port1, and Volume 9-16 is mapping to USB port2.  
¾
¾
¾
¾
¾
Capacity - The storage capacity of the USB driver.  
Used - The used space of the USB driver.  
Free - The available space of the USB driver.  
Use% - The percentage of the used space.  
Shared - Indicates the shared or non-shared status of the volume. When the volume is  
shared, you can click the Disable to stop sharing the volume; when volume is non-shared,  
you can click the Enable button to share the volume.  
Click the Start button to start the Network Sharing service.  
Click the Stop button to stop the Network Sharing service.  
Click the Eject Disk button to safely remove the USB storage device that is connected to USB  
port. This takes the drive offline. A message (as shown in Figure 5-26) will appear on your web  
browser when it is safe to detach the USB disk.  
Figure 5-26 Safe Unplug Message  
- 126 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Click the Rescan button to start a new scan.  
Follow the instructions below to set up your router as a file server:  
1. Plug an external USB hard disk drive or USB flash drive into this router.  
2. Click the Rescan button to find the USB drive that has been attached to the router.  
3. Click the Start button to start the Storage Sharing service.  
4. Click the Enable button under Shared to enable the disk to share.  
5. Click the Open the disk to visit the sharing disk.  
Note:  
)
1. The router can automatically locate new USB drive. But to display the information about your  
USB device, you need to click the Rescan button manually.  
2. The new settings will not take effect until you restart the service.  
3. To unplug the USB drive, click Eject Disk button first. Simply pulling USB drive out of the  
USB port can cause damage to the device and loss of data.  
4. Mounted volumes of each USB port are subject to the 8-volume limit. So you cannot access  
more than 8 volumes on the USB storage device.  
5. If you change the storage settings during the storage connection is established, then the  
changes will not take effect until the router or the client is rebooted.  
5.9.2 Media Server  
Choose menu “USB SettingsMedia Server”, you can create media server that allows you to  
share stored content with other computers and devices on your home network and on the Internet.  
Figure 5-27 Media Server Setting  
¾
¾
Server Name - The name of this Media Server.  
Server Status - Indicates the Media Server’s current status, started or stopped. You can  
click the Start button to start the Media Server and click the Stop button to stop it.  
Name - The display name of this folder.  
¾
¾
¾
File System - The file system type on the partition can be FAT32 or NTFS.  
Folder - The real full path of the specified folder.  
- 127 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Delete - You can delete the share folder by click Delete.  
¾
To set up your media server, please follow the instructions below:  
1. Plug an external USB hard disk drive or USB flash drive into this router, and then the screen  
will appear as shown in Figure 5-28.  
Figure 5-28 Media Server Setting  
2. Click the Start button to start the media server, and then the screen will appear as shown in  
Figure 5-29 Media Server Setting  
- 128 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
3. Click the Add share folder button to specify a folder as the search path of media server. The  
screen will then appear as shown in Figure 5-30.  
Figure 5-30 Add New Folder  
¾
¾
Display Name - You can enter a display name for the share folder.  
Share entire partition - Choose this option and then the folders contained in this  
partition will all be shared.  
¾
¾
¾
¾
¾
Folder Location- Displays the location of this folder.  
Select - Check the radio button to select the folder to share.  
Folder - Displays folders that are in current path.  
Upper - Click this button to get into the upper folder.  
Save - Click this button to save your settings and the page will be redirected to the  
media server configuration page.  
¾
Back - Click this button to discard the settings and just go to the media server  
configuration page.  
4. Click the Scan All button to scan all the share folders immediately. You can also select  
the Auto-scan, at same time, select an auto scan interval time by drop-down list. In this  
case, the media server will auto scan the share folders.  
Note:  
)
The max share folders number is 6. If you want share a new folder when the number has been  
reached to be 6, you can delete a share folder and then add a new one.  
- 129 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
5.9.3 User Accounts  
You can specify the user name and password for Storage Sharing users on this page. Storage  
Sharing users can use Internet Explorer to access files on the USB drive.  
There are two default user accounts that can access the Storage Sharing. They are Administrator  
and Guest (as shown in Figure 5-31). Administrator has read/write access to Storage Sharing and  
can access FTP Server while Guest has read-only access to Storage Sharing and cannot access  
FTP Server.  
Figure 5-31 User Account Management  
Only Administrator can use a Web browser to transfer the files from a PC to the Writable shared  
volume on the USB drive.  
To add a new user account, please follow the steps below:  
1. Click Add New User button, and the screen will appear as shown in Figure 5-32.  
2. Self-define a User Name.  
3. Enter the password in the Password field.  
4. Choose the Storage Authority from the drop-down list, Read and Write or Read Only.  
Figure 5-32 Add or Modify User Account  
- 130 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
¾
¾
¾
User Name - Type the user name that you want to give access to the USB drive. The  
user name must be composed of alphanumeric symbols not exceeding 15 characters in  
length.  
Password - Enter the password in the Password field. The password must be composed  
of alphanumeric symbols not exceeding 15 characters in length. For security purposes,  
the password for each user account is not displayed.  
Storage Authority – Choose Read and Write or Read Only from the drop-down list to  
assign access authority of Storage Sharing to the user.  
¾
¾
Save - You can click the Save button to save your settings.  
Back - You can click the Back button to discard the settings and just go to the media  
server configuration page.  
Note:  
)
Please restart the service for the new settings to take effect.  
If you cannot use the new user name and password to access the shares, press Windows logo  
+ R to open the Run dialog box and type net use \\192.168.0.254 /delete /yes and press Enter.  
(192.168.0.254 is your router's LAN IP address. If the LAN IP of the modem connected with your  
router is 192.168.1.x, the default LAN IP of the router will automatically switch from  
192.168.0.254 to 192.168.1.254 to avoid IP conflict; in this case, please try net use  
\\192.168.1.254 /delete / yes.)  
5.10 System Tools  
Figure 5-33 The System Tools menu  
Choose menu “System Tools”, and then you can see the submenus under the main menu:  
Diagnostic, Firmware Upgrade, Factory Defaults, Backup & Restore, Reboot, Password,  
and System Log. Click any of them, and you will be able to configure the corresponding function.  
The detailed explanations for each submenu are provided below.  
- 131 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
5.10.1 Diagnostic  
Choose menu “System Tools Diagnostic”, and then you can transact Ping or Traceroute  
function to check connectivity of your network in the following screen.  
Figure 5-34 Diagnostic Tools  
¾
Diagnostic Tool - Check the radio button to select one diagnostic tool.  
Ping - This diagnostic tool troubleshoots connectivity, reachability, and name resolution to  
a given host or gateway.  
Traceroute - This diagnostic tool tests the performance of a connection.  
Note:  
)
You can use ping/traceroute to test both numeric IP address or domain name. If  
pinging/tracerouting the IP address is successful, but pinging/tracerouting the domain name is not,  
you might have a name resolution problem. In this case, ensure that the domain name you are  
specifying can be resolved by using Domain Name System (DNS) queries.  
¾
IP Address/Domain Name - Type the destination IP address (e.g. 202.108.22.5) or Domain  
¾
¾
¾
Pings Count - The number of Ping packets for a Ping connection. The default is 4.  
Ping Packet Size - The size of Ping packet. The default is 64.  
Ping Timeout - Set the waiting time for the reply of each Ping packet. If there is no reply in  
the specified time, the connection is overtime. The default is 800.  
- 132 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
¾
Traceroute Max TTL - The max number of hops for a Traceroute connection. The default is  
20.  
Click Start to check the connectivity of the Internet.  
The Diagnostic Results page displays the result of diagnosis.  
If the result is similar to the following screen, the connectivity of the Internet is fine.  
Figure 5-35 Diagnostic Results  
Note:  
)
Only one user can use this tool at one time. Options “Number of Pings”, “Ping Size” and “Ping  
Timeout” are used for Ping function. Option “Tracert Hops” are used for Tracert function.  
5.10.2 Firmware Upgrade  
Choose menu “System Tools Firmware Upgrade”, and then you can update the latest  
version of firmware for the Router on the following screen.  
Figure 5-36 Firmware Upgrade  
¾
¾
Firmware Version - This displays the current firmware version.  
Hardware Version - This displays the current hardware version. The hardware version of the  
upgrade file must accord with the Router’s current hardware version.  
To upgrade the Router's firmware, follow these instructions below:  
1. Download more recent firmware upgrade file from the TP-LINK website  
a
2. Type the path and file name of the update file into the File field, or click the Browse button to  
locate the update file.  
- 133 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
3. Click the Upgrade button.  
Note:  
)
1. New firmware versions are posted at http://www.tp-link.com and can be downloaded for free.  
There is no need to upgrade the firmware unless the new firmware has a new feature you  
want to use. However, when experiencing problems caused by the Router rather than the  
configuration, you can try to upgrade the firmware.  
2. When you upgrade the Router's firmware, you may lose its current configurations, so before  
upgrading the firmware please write down some of your customized settings to avoid losing  
important settings.  
3. Do not turn off the Router or press the Reset button while the firmware is being upgraded,  
otherwise, the Router may be damaged.  
4. The Router will reboot after the upgrading has been finished.  
5.10.3 Factory Defaults  
Choose menu “System Tools Factory Defaults”, and you can restore the configurations of  
the Router to factory defaults on the following screen.  
Figure 5-37 Restore Factory Default  
Click the Restore button to reset all configuration settings to their default values.  
¾
¾
¾
¾
The default User Name: admin  
The default Password: admin  
The default IP Address: 192.168.0.254  
The default Subnet Mask: 255.255.255.0  
Note:  
)
All changed settings will be lost when defaults are restored.  
- 134 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
5.10.4 Backup & Restore  
Choose menu “System Tools Backup & Restore”, and then you can save the current  
configuration of the Router as a backup file and restore the configuration via a backup file as  
shown in Figure 5-38.  
Figure 5-38 Backup & Restore Configuration  
¾
¾
Click the Backup button to save all configuration settings as a backup file in your local  
computer.  
To upgrade the Router's configuration, follow these instructions.  
Click the Browse… button to locate the update file for the Router, or enter the exact path  
to the Setting file in the text box.  
Click the Restore button.  
Note:  
)
The current configuration will be covered by the uploading configuration file. The upgrade process  
lasts for 20 seconds and the Router will restart automatically. Keep the Router on during the  
upgrading process to prevent any damage.  
5.10.5 Reboot  
Choose menu “System Tools Reboot”, and then you can click the Reboot button to reboot  
the Router via the next screen.  
Figure 5-39 Reboot the Router  
Some settings of the Router will take effect only after rebooting, which include:  
¾
¾
¾
Change the LAN IP Address (system will reboot automatically).  
Change the DHCP Settings.  
Change the Wireless configurations.  
- 135 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Change the Web Management Port.  
¾
¾
¾
¾
Upgrade the firmware of the Router (system will reboot automatically).  
Restore the Router's settings to factory defaults (system will reboot automatically).  
Update the configuration with the file (system will reboot automatically).  
5.10.6 Password  
Choose menu “System Tools Password”, and then you can change the factory default user  
name and password of the Router in the next screen as shown in Figure 5-40.  
Figure 5-40 Password  
It is strongly recommended that you should change the factory default user name and password  
of the Router, because all users who try to access the Router's Web-based utility or Quick Setup  
will be prompted for the Router's default user name and password.  
Note:  
)
The new user name and password must not exceed 14 characters in length and not include any  
spaces. Enter the new Password twice to confirm.  
Click the Save button when finished.  
Click the Clear All button to clear all.  
- 136 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
5.10.7 System Log  
Choose menu “System Tools System Log”, and then you can view the logs of the Router.  
Figure 5-41 System Log  
¾
¾
¾
Refresh - Refresh the page to show the latest log list.  
Save Log - Click to save all the logs in a txt file.  
Mail Log - Click to send an email of current logs manually according to the address and  
validation information set in Mail Settings. The result will be shown in the later log soon.  
¾
Clear Log - All the logs will be deleted from this device permanently, not just from the page.  
- 137 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Chapter 6. Configuration for Repeater Mode  
This chapter will show each Web page's key functions and the configuration way for Repeater  
Mode of TL-WR710N.  
6.1 Login  
After your successful login, you can configure and manage the device. There are main menus on  
the left of the web-based utility. Submenus will be available after you click one of the main menus.  
On the right, there are the corresponding explanations and instructions.  
Figure 6-1  
The detailed explanations for each Web page’s key function are listed below.  
6.2 Status  
The Status page provides the current status information about the Router on Repeater Mode. All  
information is read-only.  
- 138 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure 6-2 Status  
¾
¾
¾
Firmware Version - The version information of the Router’s firmware.  
Hardware Version - The version information of the Router’s hardware.  
Wired - This field displays the current settings or information for the LAN, you can configure  
them in the Network > LAN page.  
MAC address - The physical address of the Router, as seen from the LAN.  
IP address - The LAN IP address of the Router.  
Subnet Mask - The subnet mask associated with LAN IP address.  
¾
Wireless - This field displays basic information or status for wireless function, you can  
configure them in the Wireless > Wireless Settings page.  
Working Mode - The current wireless working mode in use.  
Wireless Name of Root AP - The SSID of Root AP.  
Channel - The current wireless channel in use.  
Mode - The current wireless mode which the Router works on.  
- 139 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Channel Width - The current wireless channel width in use.  
MAC Address - The physical address of the Router, as seen from the WLAN.  
Traffic Statistics - The Router’s traffic statistics.  
¾
Received (Bytes) - Traffic that counted in bytes has been received out from the WAN port.  
Received (Packets) - Traffic that counted in packets has been received out from the WAN  
port.  
Sent (Bytes) - Traffic that counted in bytes has been sent out from the WAN port.  
Sent (Packets) - Traffic that counted in packets has been sent out from the WAN port.  
System Up Time - The length of the time since the Router was last powered on or reset.  
¾
Click the Refresh button to get the latest status and settings of the Router.  
6.3 Quick Setup  
6.4 Working Mode  
The Router supports five operation mode types: Wireless Router, Access Point, Repeater,  
Client and Wireless Client Router. Please select one you want. Click Save to save your choice,  
which is shown as Figure 5-7.  
Figure 6-3 Working Mode  
¾
Wireless Router - The wireless Router Mode. In this mode, the device enables multi-user to  
share Internet via DSL/Cable Modem. The only wired port works as WAN.  
¾
¾
¾
Access Point - The wireless access point mode.  
Repeater - The wireless Repeater Mode. It could extend the range of wireless network.  
Client - The Client Mode. The computer connected by Ethernet could get access to an AP by  
Client mode.  
- 140 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
¾
WISP Client Router - In this mode, the device enables multiple users to share Internet  
connection from WISP.  
6.5 Network  
Figure 6-4 the Network menu  
There is only one submenu under the Network menu (shown in Figure 6-4): LAN.  
6.5.1 LAN  
Choose menu “Network LAN”, and then you can configure the IP parameters of the LAN on  
the screen as below.  
Figure 6-5 LAN  
¾
¾
¾
¾
¾
MAC Address - The physical address of the LAN ports, as seen from the LAN. The value  
can't be changed.  
Type - Choosing Smart IP (DHCP) to get IP address from DHCP server, or choosing static IP  
to config IP address manually.  
IP Address - Enter the IP address of your system in dotted-decimal notation (factory default -  
192.168.0.254).  
Subnet Mask - An address code that determines the size of the network. Normally  
255.255.255.0 is used as the subnet mask.  
IGMP Proxy - The Internet Group Management Protocol(IGMP) feature allows your devices  
in LAN can watch TV.  
Note:  
)
1. If you change the IP Address of LAN, you must use the new IP Address to login to the Router.  
2. If the new LAN IP Address you set is not in the same subnet with the previous one, the IP  
Address pool in the DHCP server will be configured automaticallywhile the Virtual Server and  
DMZ Host will not take effect until they are re-configured.  
- 141 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
6.6 Wireless  
Figure 6-6 Wireless menu  
There are five submenus under the Wireless menu (shown in Figure 6-6): Wireless Settings,  
Wireless Security, MAC Filtering, Wireless Advanced and Wireless Statistics. Click it, and  
you will be able to configure the corresponding function.  
6.6.1 Wireless Settings  
Choose menu “Wireless Wireless Settings”, and then you can configure the basic settings  
for the wireless network on this page.  
Figure 6-7 Wireless Settings - Repeater  
¾
¾
¾
Wireless Name of Root AP - The SSID of AP that you want to access.  
MAC Address of Root AP - The MAC address of AP that you want to access.  
Region - Select your region from the pull-down list. This field specifies the region where the  
wireless function of the Router can be used. It may be illegal to use the wireless function of  
the Router in a region other than one of those specified in this field. If your country or region  
is not listed, please contact your local government agency for assistance.  
¾
Mode - Select the desired mode. The default setting is 11bgn mixed.  
- 142 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
11bg mixed - Select if you are using both 802.11b and 802.11g wireless clients.  
11bgn mixed - Select if you are using a mix of 802.11b, 11g, and 11n wireless clients.  
When 11bg mixed mode is selected, only 11bg mixed wireless stations can connect to the  
Router. It is strongly recommended that you set the Mode to 11bgn mixed, and all of  
802.11b/g/n wireless stations can connect to the Router.  
Note:  
)
If 11bg mixed mode is selected in the Mode field, the Channel Width selecting field will turn  
grey and the value will become 20M, which is unable to be changed.  
¾
¾
Channel Width - Select any channel width from the pull-down list. The default setting is  
automatic, which can automatically adjust the channel width for your clients.  
WDS Mode -This field determines which WDS Mode will be used. It is not necessary to  
change the WDS Mode unless you notice network communication problems with root AP. If  
you select Auto, then Router will choose the appropriate WDS Mode automatically.  
¾
¾
Enable Wireless Radio - The wireless radio of the Router can be enabled or disabled to  
allow wireless stations access. If enabled, the wireless stations will be able to access the  
Router. Otherwise, wireless stations will not be able to access the Router.  
Survey - Click this button, you can search the AP which runs in the environment.  
Click Survey button on the Wireless page as shown in Figure 6-7, and then AP List page will  
appear as shown in Figure 6-8. Find the SSID of the Access Point you want to access, and click  
Connect in the corresponding row. For example, the third item is selected. The target network’s  
SSID will be automatically filled into the corresponding box which is shown as the Figure 6-7.  
¾
Figure 6-8 AP List  
Be sure to click the Save button to save your settings on this page.  
Note:  
)
1. The operating distance or range of your wireless connection varies significantly based on the  
physical placement of the Router. For best results, place your Router.  
- 143 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Near the center of the area in which your wireless stations will operate.  
z
z
z
In an elevated location such as a high shelf.  
Away from the potential sources of interference, such as PCs, microwaves, and cordless  
phones.  
z
Away from large metal surfaces.  
2. Failure to follow these guidelines can result in significant performance degradation or inability  
to wirelessly connect to the Router.  
6.6.2 Wireless Security  
Choose menu “Wireless Wireless Security”, and then you can configure the security  
settings of your wireless network.  
There are three wireless security modes supported by the Router: WPA/WPA2-Personal,  
WPA/WPA2-Enterprise and WEP (Wired Equivalent Privacy).  
Figure 6-9 Wireless Security  
¾
Disable Security - The wireless security function can be enabled or disabled. If disabled, the  
wireless stations will be able to connect the Router without encryption. But it’s strongly  
recommended to choose one of the following modes to enable security.  
- 144 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
¾
WPA-PSK/WPA2-Personal - It’s the WPA/WPA2 authentication type based on pre-shared  
passphrase.  
Version - you can choose the version of the WPA-PSK security on the drop-down list. The  
default setting is Automatic, which can select WPA-PSK (Pre-shared key of WPA) or  
WPA2-PSK (Pre-shared key of WPA) automatically based on the wireless station's  
capability and request.  
Encryption - When WPA-PSK or WPA is set as the Authentication Type, you can select  
either Automatic, or TKIP or AES as Encryption.  
Note:  
)
If you check the WPA/WPA2-Personal radio button and choose TKIP encryption, you will find  
Figure 6-10  
¾
WPA /WPA2-Enterprise - It’s based on Radius Server.  
Version - you can choose the version of the WPA security from the pull-down list. The  
default setting is Automatic, which can select WPA (Wi-Fi Protected Access) or WPA2  
(WPA version 2) automatically based on the wireless station's capability and request.  
Encryption - You can select Automatic, TKIP or AES.  
Radius Server IP - Enter the IP address of the Radius server.  
Radius Port - Enter the port that Radius server used.  
Radius Password - Enter the password for the Radius server.  
Group Key Update Period - Specify the group key update interval in seconds. The value  
should be 30 or above. Enter 0 to disable the update.  
¾
WEP - It is based on the IEEE 802.11 standard.  
Type - you can choose the type for the WEP security on the pull-down list. The default  
setting is Automatic, which can select Shared Key or Open System authentication type  
automatically based on the wireless station's capability and request.  
WEP Key Format - Hexadecimal and ASCII formats are provided here. Hexadecimal  
format stands for any combination of hexadecimal digits (0-9, a-f, A-F) in the specified  
- 145 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
length. ASCII format stands for any combination of keyboard characters in the specified  
length.  
WEP Key (Password) - Select which of the four keys will be used and enter the matching  
WEP key that you create. Make sure these values are identical on all wireless stations in  
your network.  
Key Type - You can select the WEP key length (64-bit, or 128-bit, or 152-bit.) for  
encryption. "Disabled" means this WEP key entry is invalid.  
64-bit - You can enter 10 hexadecimal digits (any combination of 0-9, a-f, A-F, zero key is  
not promoted) or 5 ASCII characters.  
128-bit - You can enter 26 hexadecimal digits (any combination of 0-9, a-f, A-F, zero key is  
not promoted) or 13 ASCII characters.  
152-bit - You can enter 32 hexadecimal digits (any combination of 0-9, a-f, A-F, zero key is  
not promoted) or 16 ASCII characters.  
Note:  
)
If you do not set the key, the wireless security function is still disabled even if you have selected  
Shared Key as Authentication Type.  
6.6.3 Wireless MAC Filtering  
Choose menu “Wireless Wireless MAC Filtering”, and then you can control the wireless  
access by configuring the Wireless MAC Filtering function, as shown in Figure 6-11.  
Figure 6-11 Wireless MAC Filtering  
To filter wireless users by MAC Address, click Enable. The default setting is Disabled.  
¾
¾
¾
MAC Address - The wireless station's MAC address that you want to access.  
Status - The status of this entry, either Enabled or Disabled.  
Description - A simple description of the wireless station.  
- 146 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
To Add a Wireless MAC Address filtering entry, click the Add New… button. The "Add or Modify  
Wireless MAC Address Filtering entry" page will appear, shown in Figure 6-12:  
Figure 6-12 Add or Modify Wireless MAC Address Filtering entry  
To add or modify a MAC Address Filtering entry, follow these instructions:  
1. Enter the appropriate MAC Address into the MAC Address field. The format of the MAC  
Address is XX-XX-XX-XX-XX-XX (X is any hexadecimal digit). For example:  
00-0A-EB-B0-00-0B.  
2. Give a simple description for the wireless station in the Description field. For example:  
Wireless station A.  
3. Select Enabled or Disabled for this entry on the Status pull-down list.  
4. Click the Save button to save this entry.  
To modify or delete an existing entry:  
1. Click the Modify in the entry you want to modify. If you want to delete the entry, click the  
Delete.  
2. Modify the information.  
3. Click the Save button.  
Click the Enable All button to make all entries enabled  
Click the Disable All button to make all entries disabled.  
Click the Delete All button to delete all entries.  
Click the Next button to go to the next page.  
Click the Previous button to return to the previous page.  
For example: If you desire that the wireless station A with MAC address 00-0A-EB-B0-00-0B and  
the wireless station B with MAC address 00-0A-EB-00-07-5F are able to access the Router, but all  
the other wireless stations cannot access the Router, you can configure the Wireless MAC  
Address Filtering list by following these steps:  
1. Click the Enable button to enable this function.  
- 147 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
2. Select the radio button “Allow the stations specified by any enabled entries in the list to  
access” for Filtering Rules.  
3. Delete all or disable all entries if there are any entries already.  
4. Click the Add New... button.  
Enter the MAC address 00-0A-EB-B0-00-0B/00-0A-EB-00-07-5F in the MAC Address field.  
Enter wireless station A/B in the Description field.  
Select Enabled in the Status pull-down list.  
Click the Save button.  
Click the Back button.  
The filtering rules that configured should be similar to the following list:  
6.6.4 Wireless Advanced  
Choose menu “Wireless Wireless Advanced”, and then you can configure the advanced  
settings of your wireless network.  
Figure 6-13 Wireless Advanced  
¾
¾
Transmit Power - Here you can specify the transmit power of Router. You can select High,  
Middle or Low which you would like. High is the default setting and is recommended.  
Beacon Interval - Enter a value between 20-1000 milliseconds for Beacon Interval here.  
The beacons are the packets sent by the Router to synchronize a wireless network. Beacon  
Interval value determines the time interval of the beacons. The default value is 100.  
- 148 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
¾
¾
¾
RTS Threshold - Here you can specify the RTS (Request to Send) Threshold. If the packet  
is larger than the specified RTS Threshold size, the Router will send RTS frames to a  
particular receiving station and negotiate the sending of a data frame. The default value is  
2346.  
Fragmentation Threshold - This value is the maximum size determining whether packets  
will be fragmented. Setting the Fragmentation Threshold too low may result in poor network  
performance because of excessive packets. 2346 is the default setting and is  
recommended.  
DTIM Interval - This value determines the interval of the Delivery Traffic Indication Message  
(DTIM). A DTIM field is a countdown field informing clients of the next window for listening to  
broadcast and multicast messages. When the Router has buffered broadcast or multicast  
messages for associated clients, it sends the next DTIM with a DTIM Interval value. You can  
specify the value between 1-255 Beacon Intervals. The default value is 1, which indicates  
the DTIM Interval is the same as Beacon Interval.  
¾
¾
¾
Enable WMM - WMM function can guarantee the packets with high-priority messages being  
transmitted preferentially. It is strongly recommended enabled.  
Enable Short GI - This function is recommended for it will increase the data capacity by  
reducing the guard interval time.  
Enable AP Isolation - This function isolate all connected wireless stations so that wireless  
stations cannot access each other through WLAN. This function will be disabled if  
WDS/Bridge is enabled.  
Note:  
)
If you are not familiar with the setting items in this page, it's strongly recommended to keep the  
provided default values; otherwise it may result in lower wireless network performance.  
6.6.5 Wireless Statistics  
Choose menu “Wireless Wireless Statistics”, and then you can see the MAC Address,  
Current Status, Received Packets and Sent Packets for each connected wireless station.  
Figure 6-14 Wireless Statistics  
- 149 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
MAC Address - The connected wireless station's MAC address  
¾
¾
Current Status - The connected wireless station's running status, one of STA-AUTH /  
STA-ASSOC / STA-JOINED / WPA / WPA-PSK / WPA2 / WPA2-PSK / AP-UP / AP-DOWN /  
Disconnected  
¾
¾
¾
Received Packets - Packets received by the station  
Sent Packets - Packets sent by the station  
Configure - The button is used for loading the item to the Wireless MAC Filtering list.  
You cannot change any of the values on this page. To update this page and to show the current  
connected wireless stations, click on the Refresh button.  
If the numbers of connected wireless stations go beyond one page, click the Next button to go to  
the next page and click the Previous button to return the previous page.  
Note:  
)
This page will be refreshed automatically every 5 seconds.  
6.7 DHCP  
Figure 6-15 The DHCP menu  
There are three submenus under the DHCP menu (shown in Figure 6-15), DHCP Settings,  
DHCP Client List and Address Reservation. Click any of them, and you will be able to configure  
the corresponding function.  
6.7.1 DHCP Settings  
Choose menu “DHCP DHCP Settings”, and then you can configure the DHCP Server on the  
page as shown in Figure 6-16. The Router is set up by default as a DHCP (Dynamic Host  
Configuration Protocol) server, which provides the TCP/IP configuration for all the PC(s) that are  
connected to the Router in the LAN.  
- 150 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure 6-16 DHCP Settings  
¾
DHCP Server - Enable or Disable the DHCP server. If you disable the Server, you must  
have another DHCP server within your network or else you must configure the computer  
manually.  
¾
¾
¾
Start IP Address - Specify an IP address for the DHCP Server to start with when assigning  
IP addresses. 192.168.0.100 is the default start address.  
End IP Address - Specify an IP address for the DHCP Server to end with when assigning IP  
addresses. 192.168.0.199 is the default end address.  
Address Lease Time - The Address Lease Time is the amount of time a network user will  
be allowed connection to the Router with their current dynamic IP Address. Enter the  
amount of time in minutes and the user will be "leased" this dynamic IP Address. After the  
time is up, the user will be automatically assigned a new dynamic IP address. The range of  
the time is 1 ~ 2880 minutes. The default value is 120 minutes.  
¾
Default Gateway (Optional) - It is suggested to input the IP address of the LAN port of the  
Router. The default value is 192.168.0.254.  
¾
¾
Default Domain (Optional) - Input the domain name of your network.  
Primary DNS - (Optional) Input the DNS IP address provided by your ISP or consult your  
ISP.  
¾
Secondary DNS (Optional) - Input the IP address of another DNS server if your ISP  
provides two DNS servers.  
Note:  
)
1. To use the DHCP server function of the Router, you must configure all computers on the LAN  
as "Obtain an IP Address automatically".  
2. When you choose the Smart IP (DHCP) mode in Network LAN, the DHCP Server function  
will be disabled. You will see the page as below.  
- 151 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure 6-17 DHCP Settings  
6.7.2 DHCP Client List  
Choose menu “DHCP DHCP Client List”, and then you can view the information about the  
clients attached to the Router in the screen as shown in Figure 6-18.  
Figure 6-18 DHCP Client List  
¾
¾
¾
¾
Client Name - The name of the DHCP client  
MAC Address - The MAC address of the DHCP client  
Assigned IP - The IP address that the Router has allocated to the DHCP client  
Lease Time - The time of the DHCP client leased. After the dynamic IP address has expired,  
a new dynamic IP address will be automatically assigned to the user.  
You cannot change any of the values on this page. To update this page and to show the current  
attached devices, click the Refresh button.  
6.7.3 Address Reservation  
Choose menu “DHCP Address Reservation”, and then you can view and add a reserved  
address for clients via the next screen (shown in Figure 6-19).When you specify a reserved IP  
address for a PC on the LAN, that PC will always receive the same IP address each time when it  
accesses the DHCP server. Reserved IP addresses should be assigned to the servers that  
require permanent IP settings.  
- 152 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure 6-19 Address Reservation  
¾
¾
¾
¾
MAC Address - The MAC address of the PC for which you want to reserve an IP address.  
Reserved IP Address - The IP address reserved for the PC by the Router.  
Status - The status of this entry either Enabled or Disabled.  
Modify - To modify or delete an existing entry.  
To Reserve an IP address:  
1. Click the Add New… button. Then Figure 6-19 will pop-up.  
2. Enter the MAC address (in XX-XX-XX-XX-XX-XX format) and IP address (in dotted-decimal  
notation) of the computer for which you want to reserve an IP address.  
3. Click the Save button.  
Figure 6-20 Add or Modify an Address Reservation Entry  
To modify or delete an existing entry:  
1. Click the Modify in the entry you want to modify. If you want to delete the entry, click the  
Delete.  
2. Modify the information.  
3. Click the Save button.  
Click the Enable/Disable All button to make all entries enabled/disabled.  
Click the Delete All button to delete all entries.  
Click the Next button to go to the next page and Click the Previous button to return the previous  
page.  
- 153 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
6.8 USB Settings  
Figure 6-21 The USB Settings menu  
There are three submenus under the USB Settings menu (shown in Figure 6-21), Storage  
Sharing, Media Server and User Accounts. Click any of them, and you will be able to configure  
the corresponding functions.  
6.8.1 Storage Sharing  
Choose menu “USB SettingsStorage Sharing”, you can configure a USB disk drive attached  
to the router and view volume and share such properties as share name, capacity, used space,  
and free space on this page as shown below.  
Figure 6-22 Storage Sharing  
¾
¾
Service Status - Indicates the Network Sharing service's current status. You can click the  
Start button to start the Storage Sharing service and click the Stop button to stop it.  
Volume - The volume name of the USB drive the users have access to. Volume 1-8 is  
mapping to USB port1, and Volume 9-16 is mapping to USB port2.  
¾
¾
¾
¾
Capacity - The storage capacity of the USB driver.  
Used - The used space of the USB driver.  
Free - The available space of the USB driver.  
Use% - The percentage of the used space.  
- 154 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
¾
Shared - Indicates the shared or non-shared status of the volume. When the volume is  
shared, you can click the Disable to stop sharing the volume; when volume is non-shared,  
you can click the Enable button to share the volume.  
Click the Start button to start the Network Sharing service.  
Click the Stop button to stop the Network Sharing service.  
Click the Eject Disk button to safely remove the USB storage device that is connected to USB  
port. This takes the drive offline. A message (as shown in Figure 6-23) will appear on your web  
browser when it is safe to detach the USB disk.  
Figure 6-23 Safe Unplug Message  
Click the Rescan button to start a new scan.  
Follow the instructions below to set up your router as a file server:  
1. Plug an external USB hard disk drive or USB flash drive into this router.  
2. Click the Rescan button to find the USB drive that has been attached to the router.  
3. Click the Start button to start the Storage Sharing service.  
4. Click the Enable button under Shared to enable the disk to share.  
5. Click the Open the disk to visit the sharing disk.  
Note:  
)
1. The router can automatically locate new USB drive. But to display the information about your  
USB device, you need to click the Rescan button manually.  
2. The new settings will not take effect until you restart the service.  
3. To unplug the USB drive, click Eject Disk button first. Simply pulling USB drive out of the  
USB port can cause damage to the device and loss of data.  
4. Mounted volumes of each USB port are subject to the 8-volume limit. So you cannot access  
more than 8 volumes on the USB storage device.  
5. If you change the storage settings during the storage connection is established, then the  
changes will not take effect until the router or the client is rebooted.  
- 155 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
6.8.2 Media Server  
Choose menu “USB SettingsMedia Server”, you can create media server that allows you to  
share stored content with other computers and devices on your home network and on the Internet.  
Figure 6-24 Media Server Setting  
¾
¾
Server Name - The name of this Media Server.  
Server Status - Indicates the Media Server’s current status, started or stopped. You can  
click the Start button to start the Media Server and click the Stop button to stop it.  
Name - The display name of this folder.  
¾
¾
¾
¾
File System - The file system type on the partition can be FAT32 or NTFS.  
Folder - The real full path of the specified folder.  
Delete - You can delete the share folder by click Delete.  
To set up your media server, please follow the instructions below:  
1. Plug an external USB hard disk drive or USB flash drive into this router, and then the screen  
will appear as shown in Figure 6-25.  
Figure 6-25 Media Server Setting  
- 156 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
2. Click the Start button to start the media server, and then the screen will appear as shown in  
Figure 6-26 Media Server Setting  
3. Click the Add share folder button to specify a folder as the search path of media server. The  
screen will then appear as shown in Figure 6-27.  
Figure 6-27 Add New Folder  
¾
¾
Display Name - You can enter a display name for the share folder.  
Share entire partition - Choose this option and then the folders contained in this  
partition will all be shared.  
¾
¾
¾
¾
¾
Folder Location- Displays the location of this folder.  
Select - Check the radio button to select the folder to share.  
Folder - Displays folders that are in current path.  
Upper - Click this button to get into the upper folder.  
Save - Click this button to save your settings and the page will be redirected to the  
media server configuration page.  
- 157 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
¾
Back - Click this button to discard the settings and just go to the media server  
configuration page.  
4. Click the Scan All button to scan all the share folders immediately. You can also select the  
Auto-scan, at same time, select an auto scan interval time by drop-down list. In this case, the  
media server will auto scan the share folders.  
Note:  
)
The max share folders number is 6. If you want share a new folder when the number has been  
reached to be 6, you can delete a share folder and then add a new one.  
6.8.3 User Accounts  
You can specify the user name and password for Storage Sharing users on this page. Storage  
Sharing users can use Internet Explorer to access files on the USB drive.  
There are two default user accounts that can access the Storage Sharing. They are Administrator  
and Guest (as shown in Figure 6-28). Administrator has read/write access to Storage Sharing and  
can access FTP Server while Guest has read-only access to Storage Sharing and cannot access  
FTP Server.  
Figure 6-28 User Account Management  
Only Administrator can use a Web browser to transfer the files from a PC to the Writable shared  
volume on the USB drive.  
To add a new user account, please follow the steps below:  
1. Click Add New User button, and the screen will appear as shown in Figure 6-29.  
2. Self-define a User Name.  
3. Enter the password in the Password field.  
- 158 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
4. Choose the Storage Authority from the drop-down list, Read and Write or Read Only.  
Figure 6-29 Add or Modify User Account  
¾
¾
¾
User Name - Type the user name that you want to give access to the USB drive. The  
user name must be composed of alphanumeric symbols not exceeding 15 characters in  
length.  
Password - Enter the password in the Password field. The password must be composed  
of alphanumeric symbols not exceeding 15 characters in length. For security purposes,  
the password for each user account is not displayed.  
Storage Authority – Choose Read and Write or Read Only from the drop-down list to  
assign access authority of Storage Sharing to the user.  
¾
¾
Save - You can click the Save button to save your settings.  
Back - You can click the Back button to discard the settings and just go to the media  
server configuration page.  
Note:  
)
Please restart the service for the new settings to take effect.  
If you cannot use the new user name and password to access the shares, press Windows logo +  
R to open the Run dialog box and type net use \\192.168.0.254 /delete /yes and press Enter.  
(192.168.0.254 is your router's LAN IP address. If the LAN IP of the modem connected with your  
router is 192.168.1.x, the default LAN IP of the router will automatically switch from 192.168.0.254  
to 192.168.1.254 to avoid IP conflict; in this case, please try net use \\192.168.1.254 /delete /  
yes.)  
- 159 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
6.9 System Tools  
Figure 6-30 The System Tools menu  
Choose menu “System Tools”, and then you can see the submenus under the main menu:  
Diagnostic, Firmware Upgrade, Factory Defaults, Backup & Restore, Reboot, Password,  
and System Log. Click any of them, and you will be able to configure the corresponding function.  
The detailed explanations for each submenu are provided below.  
6.9.1 Diagnostic  
Choose menu “System Tools Diagnostic”, and then you can transact Ping or Traceroute  
function to check connectivity of your network in the following screen.  
Figure 6-31 Diagnostic Tools  
¾
Diagnostic Tool - Check the radio button to select one diagnostic tool.  
- 160 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Ping - This diagnostic tool troubleshoots connectivity, reachability, and name resolution to  
a given host or gateway.  
Traceroute - This diagnostic tool tests the performance of a connection.  
Note:  
)
You can use ping/traceroute to test both numeric IP address or domain name. If  
pinging/tracerouting the IP address is successful, but pinging/tracerouting the domain name is not,  
you might have a name resolution problem. In this case, ensure that the domain name you are  
specifying can be resolved by using Domain Name System (DNS) queries.  
¾
IP Address/Domain Name - Type the destination IP address (e.g. 202.108.22.5) or Domain  
¾
¾
¾
Pings Count - The number of Ping packets for a Ping connection. The default is 4.  
Ping Packet Size - The size of Ping packet. The default is 64.  
Ping Timeout - Set the waiting time for the reply of each Ping packet. If there is no reply in  
the specified time, the connection is overtime. The default is 800.  
¾
Traceroute Max TTL - The max number of hops for a Traceroute connection. The default is  
20.  
Click Start to check the connectivity of the Internet.  
The Diagnostic Results page displays the result of diagnosis.  
If the result is similar to the following screen, the connectivity of the Internet is fine.  
Figure 6-32 Diagnostic Results  
Note:  
)
Only one user can use this tool at one time. Options “Number of Pings”, “Ping Size” and “Ping  
Timeout” are used for Ping function. Option “Tracert Hops” are used for Tracert function.  
- 161 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
6.9.2 Firmware Upgrade  
Choose menu “System Tools Firmware Upgrade”, and then you can update the latest  
version of firmware for the Router on the following screen.  
Figure 6-33 Firmware Upgrade  
¾
¾
Firmware Version - This displays the current firmware version.  
Hardware Version - This displays the current hardware version. The hardware version of the  
upgrade file must accord with the Router’s current hardware version.  
To upgrade the Router's firmware, follow these instructions below:  
1. Download more recent firmware upgrade file from the TP-LINK website  
a
2. Type the path and file name of the update file into the File field, or click the Browse button to  
locate the update file.  
3. Click the Upgrade button.  
Note:  
)
1. New firmware versions are posted at http://www.tp-link.com and can be downloaded for free.  
There is no need to upgrade the firmware unless the new firmware has a new feature you  
want to use. However, when experiencing problems caused by the Router rather than the  
configuration, you can try to upgrade the firmware.  
2. When you upgrade the Router's firmware, you may lose its current configurations, so before  
upgrading the firmware please write down some of your customized settings to avoid losing  
important settings.  
3. Do not turn off the Router or press the Reset button while the firmware is being upgraded,  
otherwise, the Router may be damaged.  
4. The Router will reboot after the upgrading has been finished.  
- 162 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
6.9.3 Factory Defaults  
Choose menu “System Tools Factory Defaults”, and you can restore the configurations of  
the Router to factory defaults on the following screen.  
Figure 6-34 Restore Factory Default  
Click the Restore button to reset all configuration settings to their default values.  
¾
¾
¾
¾
The default User Name: admin  
The default Password: admin  
The default IP Address: 192.168.0.254  
The default Subnet Mask: 255.255.255.0  
Note:  
)
All changed settings will be lost when defaults are restored.  
6.9.4 Backup & Restore  
Choose menu “System Tools Backup & Restore”, and then you can save the current  
configuration of the Router as a backup file and restore the configuration via a backup file as  
shown in Figure 6-35.  
Figure 6-35 Backup & Restore Configuration  
¾
¾
Click the Backup button to save all configuration settings as a backup file in your local  
computer.  
To upgrade the Router's configuration, follow these instructions.  
Click the Browse… button to locate the update file for the Router, or enter the exact path  
to the Setting file in the text box.  
Click the Restore button.  
- 163 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Note:  
)
The current configuration will be covered by the uploading configuration file. The upgrade process  
lasts for 20 seconds and the Router will restart automatically. Keep the Router on during the  
upgrading process to prevent any damage.  
6.9.5 Reboot  
Choose menu “System Tools Reboot”, and then you can click the Reboot button to reboot  
the Router via the next screen.  
Figure 6-36 Reboot the Router  
Some settings of the Router will take effect only after rebooting, including:  
¾
¾
¾
¾
¾
¾
¾
Change the LAN IP Address (system will reboot automatically).  
Change the DHCP Settings.  
Change the Wireless configurations.  
Change the Web Management Port.  
Upgrade the firmware of the Router (system will reboot automatically).  
Restore the Router's settings to factory defaults (system will reboot automatically).  
Update the configuration with the file (system will reboot automatically.  
- 164 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
6.9.6 Password  
Choose menu “System Tools Password”, and then you can change the factory default user  
name and password of the Router in the next screen as shown in Figure 6-37.  
Figure 6-37 Password  
It is strongly recommended that you should change the factory default user name and password  
of the Router, because all users who try to access the Router's Web-based utility or Quick Setup  
will be prompted for the Router's default user name and password.  
Note:  
)
The new user name and password must not exceed 14 characters in length and not include any  
spaces. Enter the new Password twice to confirm.  
Click the Save button when finished.  
Click the Clear All button to clear all.  
- 165 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
6.9.7 System Log  
Choose menu “System Tools System Log”, and then you can view the logs of the Router.  
Figure 6-38 System Log  
¾
¾
¾
Refresh - Refresh the page to show the latest log list.  
Save Log - Click to save all the logs in a txt file.  
Mail Log - Click to send an email of current logs manually according to the address and  
validation information set in Mail Settings. The result will be shown in the later log soon.  
¾
Clear Log - All the logs will be deleted from this device permanently, not just from the page.  
- 166 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Chapter 7. Configuration for Client Mode  
This chapter will show each Web page's key functions and the configuration way for Client Mode  
of TL-WR710N.  
7.1 Login  
After your successful login, you can configure and manage the device. There are main menus on  
the left of the web-based utility. Submenus will be available after you click one of the main menus.  
On the right, there are the corresponding explanations and instructions.  
Figure 7-1  
The detailed explanations for each Web page’s key function are listed below.  
7.2 Status  
The Status page provides the current status information about the Router on Client Mode. All  
information is read-only.  
- 167 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure 7-2 Status  
¾
¾
¾
Firmware Version - The version information of the Router’s firmware.  
Hardware Version - The version information of the Router’s hardware.  
Wired - This field displays the current settings or information for the LAN, you can configure  
them in the Network > LAN page.  
MAC address - The physical address of the Router, as seen from the LAN.  
IP address - The LAN IP address of the Router.  
Subnet Mask - The subnet mask associated with LAN IP address.  
¾
Wireless - This field displays basic information or status for wireless function, you can  
configure them in the Wireless > Wireless Settings page.  
Working Mode - The current wireless working mode in use.  
Wireless Name of Root AP - The SSID of Root AP.  
Channel - The current wireless channel in use.  
Mode - The current wireless mode which the Router works on.  
- 168 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Channel Width - The current wireless channel width in use.  
MAC Address - The physical address of the Router, as seen from the WLAN.  
Traffic Statistics - The Router’s traffic statistics.  
¾
Received (Bytes) - Traffic that counted in bytes has been received out from the WAN port.  
Received (Packets) - Traffic that counted in packets has been received out from the WAN  
port.  
Sent (Bytes) - Traffic that counted in bytes has been sent out from the WAN port.  
Sent (Packets) - Traffic that counted in packets has been sent out from the WAN port.  
System Up Time - The length of the time since the Router was last powered on or reset.  
¾
Click the Refresh button to get the latest status and settings of the Router.  
7.3 Quick Setup  
7.4 Working Mode  
The Router supports five operation mode types: Wireless Router, Access Point, Repeater,  
Client and Wireless Client Router. Please select one you want. Click Save to save your choice,  
which is shown as Figure 7-3.  
Figure 7-3 Working Mode  
¾
Wireless Router - The wireless Router Mode. In this mode, the device enables multi-user to  
share Internet via DSL/Cable Modem. The only wired port works as WAN.  
¾
¾
¾
Access Point - The wireless access point mode.  
Repeater - The wireless Repeater Mode. It could extend the range of wireless network.  
Client - The Client Mode. The computer connected by Ethernet could get access to an AP by  
Client mode.  
- 169 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
¾
WISP Client Router - In this mode, the device enables multiple users to share Internet  
connection from WISP.  
7.5 Network  
Figure 7-4 the Network menu  
There is only one submenu under the Network menu (shown in Figure 7-4): LAN.  
7.5.1 LAN  
Choose menu “Network LAN”, and then you can configure the IP parameters of the LAN on  
the screen as below.  
Figure 7-5 LAN  
¾
¾
¾
¾
¾
MAC Address - The physical address of the LAN ports, as seen from the LAN. The value  
can't be changed.  
Type - Choosing Smart IP (DHCP) to get IP address from DHCP server, or choosing static IP  
to config IP address manually.  
IP Address - Enter the IP address of your system in dotted-decimal notation (factory default -  
192.168.0.254).  
Subnet Mask - An address code that determines the size of the network. Normally  
255.255.255.0 is used as the subnet mask.  
IGMP Proxy - The Internet Group Management Protocol(IGMP) feature allows your devices  
in LAN can watch TV.  
Note:  
)
1. If you change the IP Address of LAN, you must use the new IP Address to login to the Router.  
2. If the new LAN IP Address you set is not in the same subnet with the previous one, the IP  
Address pool in the DHCP server will be configured automaticallywhile the Virtual Server and  
DMZ Host will not take effect until they are re-configured.  
- 170 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
3. When you choose the Smart IP (DHCP) mode, the DHCP Server function will be disabled.  
7.6 Wireless  
Figure 7-6 Wireless menu  
There are two submenus under the Wireless menu (shown in Figure 7-6): Wireless Settings and  
Wireless Security. Click any of them, and you will be able to configure the corresponding  
function.  
7.6.1 Wireless Settings  
Choose menu “Wireless Wireless Settings”, and then you can configure the basic settings  
for the wireless network on this page.  
Figure 7-7 Wireless Settings - Client  
¾
¾
¾
Wireless Name of Root AP - Enter the SSID of AP that you want to access.  
MAC Address of Root AP - Enter the MAC address of AP that you want to access.  
Region - Select your region from the pull-down list. This field specifies the region where the  
wireless function of the Router can be used. It may be illegal to use the wireless function of  
the Router in a region other than one of those specified in this field. If your country or region  
is not listed, please contact your local government agency for assistance.  
¾
WDS Mode -This field determines which WDS Mode will be used. It is not necessary to  
change the WDS Mode unless you notice network communication problems with root AP. If  
you select Auto, then Router will choose the appropriate WDS Mode automatically.  
- 171 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
¾
Enable Wireless Radio - The wireless radio of the AP can be enabled or disabled to allow or  
deny wireless stations to access. If enabled, the wireless stations will be able to access the AP,  
otherwise, wireless stations will not be able to access the AP.  
¾
Survey - Click this button, you can search the APs.  
Note:  
)
1. The operating distance or range of your wireless connection varies significantly based on the  
physical placement of the Router. For best results, place your Router.  
z
z
z
Near the center of the area in which your wireless stations will operate.  
In an elevated location such as a high shelf.  
Away from the potential sources of interference, such as PCs, microwaves, and cordless  
phones.  
z
Away from large metal surfaces.  
2. Failure to follow these guidelines can result in significant performance degradation or inability  
to wirelessly connect to the Router.  
7.6.2 Wireless Security  
Choose menu “Wireless Wireless Security”, and then you can configure the security  
settings of your wireless network.  
There are three wireless security modes supported by the Router: WPA/WPA2-Personal,  
WPA/WPA2-Enterprise and WEP (Wired Equivalent Privacy).  
- 172 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure 7-8 Wireless Security  
¾
¾
Disable Security - The wireless security function can be enabled or disabled. If disabled, the  
wireless stations will be able to connect the Router without encryption. But it’s strongly  
recommended to choose one of the following modes to enable security.  
WPA-PSK/WPA2-Personal - It’s the WPA/WPA2 authentication type based on pre-shared  
passphrase.  
Version - you can choose the version of the WPA-PSK security on the drop-down list. The  
default setting is Automatic, which can select WPA-PSK (Pre-shared key of WPA) or  
WPA2-PSK (Pre-shared key of WPA) automatically based on the wireless station's  
capability and request.  
Encryption - When WPA-PSK or WPA is set as the Authentication Type, you can select  
either Automatic, or TKIP or AES as Encryption.  
Note:  
)
If you check the WPA/WPA2-Personal radio button and choose TKIP encryption, you will find  
a notice in red as shown in Figure 7-9.  
- 173 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure 7-9  
¾
WPA /WPA2-Enterprise - It’s based on Radius Server.  
Version - you can choose the version of the WPA security from the pull-down list. The  
default setting is Automatic, which can select WPA (Wi-Fi Protected Access) or WPA2  
(WPA version 2) automatically based on the wireless station's capability and request.  
Encryption - You can select Automatic, TKIP or AES.  
Radius Server IP - Enter the IP address of the Radius server.  
Radius Port - Enter the port that Radius server used.  
Radius Password - Enter the password for the Radius server.  
Group Key Update Period - Specify the group key update interval in seconds. The value  
should be 30 or above. Enter 0 to disable the update.  
¾
WEP - It is based on the IEEE 802.11 standard.  
Type - you can choose the type for the WEP security on the pull-down list. The default  
setting is Automatic, which can select Shared Key or Open System authentication type  
automatically based on the wireless station's capability and request.  
WEP Key Format - Hexadecimal and ASCII formats are provided here. Hexadecimal  
format stands for any combination of hexadecimal digits (0-9, a-f, A-F) in the specified  
length. ASCII format stands for any combination of keyboard characters in the specified  
length.  
WEP Key (Password) - Select which of the four keys will be used and enter the matching  
WEP key that you create. Make sure these values are identical on all wireless stations in  
your network.  
Key Type - You can select the WEP key length (64-bit, or 128-bit, or 152-bit.) for  
encryption. "Disabled" means this WEP key entry is invalid.  
64-bit - You can enter 10 hexadecimal digits (any combination of 0-9, a-f, A-F, zero key is  
not promoted) or 5 ASCII characters.  
128-bit - You can enter 26 hexadecimal digits (any combination of 0-9, a-f, A-F, zero key is  
not promoted) or 13 ASCII characters.  
- 174 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
152-bit - You can enter 32 hexadecimal digits (any combination of 0-9, a-f, A-F, zero key is  
not promoted) or 16 ASCII characters.  
Note:  
)
If you do not set the key, the wireless security function is still disabled even if you have selected  
Shared Key as Authentication Type.  
7.7 DHCP  
Figure 7-10 The DHCP menu  
There are three submenus under the DHCP menu (shown in Figure 7-10), DHCP Settings,  
DHCP Client List and Address Reservation. Click any of them, and you will be able to configure  
the corresponding function.  
7.7.1 DHCP Settings  
Choose menu “DHCP DHCP Settings”, and then you can configure the DHCP Server on the  
page as shown in Figure 7-11. The Router is set up by default as a DHCP (Dynamic Host  
Configuration Protocol) server, which provides the TCP/IP configuration for all the PC(s) that are  
connected to the Router in the LAN.  
Figure 7-11 DHCP Settings  
¾
DHCP Server - Enable or Disable the DHCP server. If you disable the Server, you must  
have another DHCP server within your network or else you must configure the computer  
manually.  
- 175 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
¾
¾
¾
Start IP Address - Specify an IP address for the DHCP Server to start with when assigning  
IP addresses. 192.168.0.100 is the default start address.  
End IP Address - Specify an IP address for the DHCP Server to end with when assigning IP  
addresses. 192.168.0.199 is the default end address.  
Address Lease Time - The Address Lease Time is the amount of time a network user will  
be allowed connection to the Router with their current dynamic IP Address. Enter the  
amount of time in minutes and the user will be "leased" this dynamic IP Address. After the  
time is up, the user will be automatically assigned a new dynamic IP address. The range of  
the time is 1 ~ 2880 minutes. The default value is 120 minutes.  
¾
Default Gateway (Optional) - It is suggested to input the IP address of the LAN port of the  
Router. The default value is 192.168.0.254.  
¾
¾
Default Domain (Optional) - Input the domain name of your network.  
Primary DNS - (Optional) Input the DNS IP address provided by your ISP or consult your  
ISP.  
¾
Secondary DNS (Optional) - Input the IP address of another DNS server if your ISP  
provides two DNS servers.  
Note:  
)
1. To use the DHCP server function of the Router, you must configure all computers on the LAN  
as "Obtain an IP Address automatically". This function will take effect until this device reboots.  
2. When you choose the Smart IP (DHCP) mode in Network LAN, the DHCP Server  
function will be disabled. You will see the page as below.  
Figure 7-12 DHCP Settings  
- 176 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
7.7.2 DHCP Client List  
Choose menu “DHCP DHCP Client List”, and then you can view the information about the  
clients attached to the Router in the screen as shown in Figure 7-13.  
Figure 7-13 DHCP Clients List  
¾
¾
¾
¾
Client Name - The name of the DHCP client  
MAC Address - The MAC address of the DHCP client  
Assigned IP - The IP address that the Router has allocated to the DHCP client  
Lease Time - The time of the DHCP client leased. After the dynamic IP address has expired,  
a new dynamic IP address will be automatically assigned to the user.  
You cannot change any of the values on this page. To update this page and to show the current  
attached devices, click the Refresh button.  
7.7.3 Address Reservation  
Choose menu “DHCP Address Reservation”, and then you can view and add a reserved  
address for clients via the next screen (shown in Figure 7-14).When you specify a reserved IP  
address for a PC on the LAN, that PC will always receive the same IP address each time when it  
accesses the DHCP server. Reserved IP addresses should be assigned to the servers that  
require permanent IP settings.  
Figure 7-14 Address Reservation  
¾
¾
¾
MAC Address - The MAC address of the PC for which you want to reserve an IP address.  
Reserved IP Address - The IP address reserved for the PC by the Router.  
Status - The status of this entry either Enabled or Disabled.  
- 177 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
¾
Modify - To modify or delete an existing entry.  
To Reserve an IP address:  
1. Click the Add New… button. Then Figure 7-15 will pop-up.  
2. Enter the MAC address (in XX-XX-XX-XX-XX-XX format.) and IP address (in dotted-decimal  
notation) of the computer for which you want to reserve an IP address.  
3. Click the Save button.  
Figure 7-15 Add or Modify an Address Reservation Entry  
To modify or delete an existing entry:  
1. Click the Modify in the entry you want to modify. If you want to delete the entry, click the  
Delete.  
2. Modify the information.  
3. Click the Save button.  
Click the Enable/Disable All button to make all entries enabled/disabled  
Click the Delete All button to delete all entries.  
Click the Next button to go to the next page and Click the Previous button to return the  
previous page.  
7.8 USB Settings  
Figure 7-16 The USB Settings menu  
There are three submenus under the USB Settings menu (shown in Figure 7-16), Storage  
Sharing, Media Server and User Accounts. Click any of them, and you will be able to configure  
the corresponding functions.  
- 178 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
7.8.1 Storage Sharing  
Choose menu “USB SettingsStorage Sharing”, you can configure a USB disk drive attached  
to the router and view volume and share such properties as share name, capacity, used space,  
and free space on this page as shown below.  
Figure 7-17 Storage Sharing  
¾
¾
Service Status - Indicates the Network Sharing service's current status. You can click the  
Start button to start the Storage Sharing service and click the Stop button to stop it.  
Volume - The volume name of the USB drive the users have access to. Volume 1-8 is  
mapping to USB port1, and Volume 9-16 is mapping to USB port2.  
¾
¾
¾
¾
¾
Capacity - The storage capacity of the USB driver.  
Used - The used space of the USB driver.  
Free - The available space of the USB driver.  
Use% - The percentage of the used space.  
Shared - Indicates the shared or non-shared status of the volume. When the volume is  
shared, you can click the Disable to stop sharing the volume; when volume is non-shared,  
you can click the Enable button to share the volume.  
Click the Start button to start the Network Sharing service.  
Click the Stop button to stop the Network Sharing service.  
Click the Eject Disk button to safely remove the USB storage device that is connected to USB  
port. This takes the drive offline. A message (as shown in Figure 7-18) will appear on your web  
browser when it is safe to detach the USB disk.  
- 179 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure 7-18 Safe Unplug Message  
Click the Rescan button to start a new scan.  
Follow the instructions below to set up your router as a file server:  
1. Plug an external USB hard disk drive or USB flash drive into this router.  
2. Click the Rescan button to find the USB drive that has been attached to the router.  
3. Click the Start button to start the Storage Sharing service.  
4. Click the Enable button under Shared to enable the disk to share.  
5. Click the Open the disk to visit the sharing disk.  
Note:  
)
1. The router can automatically locate new USB drive. But to display the information about your  
USB device, you need to click the Rescan button manually.  
2. The new settings will not take effect until you restart the service.  
3. To unplug the USB drive, click Eject Disk button first. Simply pulling USB drive out of the  
USB port can cause damage to the device and loss of data.  
4. Mounted volumes of each USB port are subject to the 8-volume limit. So you cannot access  
more than 8 volumes on the USB storage device.  
5. If you change the storage settings during the storage connection is established, then the  
changes will not take effect until the router or the client is rebooted.  
- 180 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
7.8.2 Media Server  
Choose menu “USB SettingsMedia Server”, you can create media server that allows you to  
share stored content with other computers and devices on your home network and on the Internet.  
Figure 7-19 Media Server Setting  
¾
¾
Server Name - The name of this Media Server.  
Server Status - Indicates the Media Server’s current status, started or stopped. You can  
click the Start button to start the Media Server and click the Stop button to stop it.  
Name - The display name of this folder.  
¾
¾
¾
¾
File System - The file system type on the partition can be FAT32 or NTFS.  
Folder - The real full path of the specified folder.  
Delete - You can delete the share folder by click Delete.  
To set up your media server, please follow the instructions below:  
1. Plug an external USB hard disk drive or USB flash drive into this router, and then the screen  
will appear as shown in Figure 7-20.  
Figure 7-20 Media Server Setting  
- 181 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
2. Click the Start button to start the media server, and then the screen will appear as shown in  
Figure 7-21 Media Server Setting  
3. Click the Add share folder button to specify a folder as the search path of media server. The  
screen will then appear as shown in Figure 7-22.  
Figure 7-22 Add New Folder  
¾
¾
Display Name - You can enter a display name for the share folder.  
Share entire partition - Choose this option and then the folders contained in this partition  
will all be shared.  
¾
¾
¾
¾
¾
Folder Location- Displays the location of this folder.  
Select - Check the radio button to select the folder to share.  
Folder - Displays folders that are in current path.  
Upper - Click this button to get into the upper folder.  
Save - Click this button to save your settings and the page will be redirected to the media  
server configuration page.  
- 182 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
¾
Back - Click this button to discard the settings and just go to the media server configuration  
page.  
4. Click the Scan All button to scan all the share folders immediately. You can also select the  
Auto-scan, at same time, select an auto scan interval time by drop-down list. In this case, the  
media server will auto scan the share folders.  
Note:  
)
The max share folders number is 6. If you want share a new folder when the number has been  
reached to be 6, you can delete a share folder and then add a new one.  
7.8.3 User Accounts  
You can specify the user name and password for Storage Sharing users on this page. Storage  
Sharing users can use Internet Explorer to access files on the USB drive.  
There are two default user accounts that can access the Storage Sharing. They are Administrator  
and Guest (as shown in Figure 7-23). Administrator has read/write access to Storage Sharing and  
can access FTP Server while Guest has read-only access to Storage Sharing and cannot access  
FTP Server.  
Figure 7-23 User Account Management  
Only Administrator can use a Web browser to transfer the files from a PC to the Writable shared  
volume on the USB drive.  
To add a new user account, please follow the steps below:  
1. Click Add New User button, and the screen will appear as shown in Figure 7-23.  
2. Self-define a User Name.  
3. Enter the password in the Password field.  
- 183 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
4. Choose the Storage Authority from the drop-down list, Read and Write or Read Only.  
Figure 7-24 Add or Modify User Account  
¾
¾
User Name - Type the user name that you want to give access to the USB drive. The user  
name must be composed of alphanumeric symbols not exceeding 15 characters in length.  
Password - Enter the password in the Password field. The password must be composed of  
alphanumeric symbols not exceeding 15 characters in length. For security purposes, the  
password for each user account is not displayed.  
¾
Storage Authority – Choose Read and Write or Read Only from the drop-down list to  
assign access authority of Storage Sharing to the user.  
¾
¾
Save - You can click the Save button to save your settings.  
Back - You can click the Back button to discard the settings and just go to the media server  
configuration page.  
Note:  
)
Please restart the service for the new settings to take effect.  
If you cannot use the new user name and password to access the shares, press Windows logo +  
R to open the Run dialog box and type net use \\192.168.0.254 /delete /yes and press Enter.  
(192.168.0.254 is your router's LAN IP address. If the LAN IP of the modem connected with your  
router is 192.168.1.x, the default LAN IP of the router will automatically switch from 192.168.0.254  
to 192.168.1.254 to avoid IP conflict; in this case, please try net use \\192.168.1.254 /delete /  
yes.)  
- 184 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
7.9 System Tools  
Figure 7-25 The System Tools menu  
Choose menu “System Tools”, and then you can see the submenus under the main menu:  
Diagnostic, Firmware Upgrade, Factory Defaults, Backup & Restore, Reboot, Password,  
and System Log. Click any of them, and you will be able to configure the corresponding function.  
The detailed explanations for each submenu are provided below.  
7.9.1 Diagnostic  
Choose menu “System Tools Diagnostic”, and then you can transact Ping or Traceroute  
function to check connectivity of your network in the following screen.  
Figure 7-26 Diagnostic Tools  
- 185 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Diagnostic Tool - Check the radio button to select one diagnostic tool.  
¾
Ping - This diagnostic tool troubleshoots connectivity, reachability, and name resolution to  
a given host or gateway.  
Traceroute - This diagnostic tool tests the performance of a connection.  
Note:  
)
You can use ping/traceroute to test both numeric IP address or domain name. If  
pinging/tracerouting the IP address is successful, but pinging/tracerouting the domain name is not,  
you might have a name resolution problem. In this case, ensure that the domain name you are  
specifying can be resolved by using Domain Name System (DNS) queries.  
¾
IP Address/Domain Name - Type the destination IP address (e.g. 202.108.22.5) or Domain  
¾
¾
¾
Pings Count - The number of Ping packets for a Ping connection. The default is 4.  
Ping Packet Size - The size of Ping packet. The default is 64.  
Ping Timeout - Set the waiting time for the reply of each Ping packet. If there is no reply in  
the specified time, the connection is overtime. The default is 800.  
¾
Traceroute Max TTL - The max number of hops for a Traceroute connection. The default is  
20.  
Click Start to check the connectivity of the Internet.  
The Diagnostic Results page displays the result of diagnosis.  
If the result is similar to the following screen, the connectivity of the Internet is fine.  
Figure 7-27 Diagnostic Results  
Note:  
)
Only one user can use this tool at one time. Options “Number of Pings”, “Ping Size” and “Ping  
Timeout” are used for Ping function. Option “Tracert Hops” are used for Tracert function.  
- 186 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
7.9.2 Firmware Upgrade  
Choose menu “System Tools Firmware Upgrade”, and then you can update the latest  
version of firmware for the Router on the following screen.  
Figure 7-28 Firmware Upgrade  
¾
¾
Firmware Version - This displays the current firmware version.  
Hardware Version - This displays the current hardware version. The hardware version of the  
upgrade file must accord with the Router’s current hardware version.  
To upgrade the Router's firmware, follow these instructions below:  
1. Download more recent firmware upgrade file from the TP-LINK website  
a
2. Type the path and file name of the update file into the File field, or click the Browse button to  
locate the update file.  
3. Click the Upgrade button.  
Note:  
)
1. New firmware versions are posted at http://www.tp-link.com and can be downloaded for free.  
There is no need to upgrade the firmware unless the new firmware has a new feature you  
want to use. However, when experiencing problems caused by the Router rather than the  
configuration, you can try to upgrade the firmware.  
2. When you upgrade the Router's firmware, you may lose its current configurations, so before  
upgrading the firmware please write down some of your customized settings to avoid losing  
important settings.  
3. Do not turn off the Router or press the Reset button while the firmware is being upgraded,  
otherwise, the Router may be damaged.  
4. The Router will reboot after the upgrading has been finished.  
- 187 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
7.9.3 Factory Defaults  
Choose menu “System Tools Factory Defaults”, and you can restore the configurations of  
the Router to factory defaults on the following screen.  
Figure 7-29 Restore Factory Default  
Click the Restore button to reset all configuration settings to their default values.  
¾
¾
¾
¾
The default User Name: admin  
The default Password: admin  
The default IP Address: 192.168.0.254  
The default Subnet Mask: 255.255.255.0  
Note:  
)
All changed settings will be lost when defaults are restored.  
7.9.4 Backup & Restore  
Choose menu “System Tools Backup & Restore”, and then you can save the current  
configuration of the Router as a backup file and restore the configuration via a backup file as  
shown in Figure 7-30.  
Figure 7-30 Backup & Restore Configuration  
¾
¾
Click the Backup button to save all configuration settings as a backup file in your local  
computer.  
To upgrade the Router's configuration, follow these instructions.  
Click the Browse… button to locate the update file for the Router, or enter the exact path  
to the Setting file in the text box.  
Click the Restore button.  
- 188 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Note:  
)
The current configuration will be covered by the uploading configuration file. The upgrade process  
lasts for 20 seconds and the Router will restart automatically. Keep the Router on during the  
upgrading process to prevent any damage.  
7.9.5 Reboot  
Choose menu “System Tools Reboot”, and then you can click the Reboot button to reboot  
the Router via the next screen.  
Figure 7-31 Reboot the Router  
Some settings of the Router will take effect only after rebooting, which include:  
¾
¾
¾
¾
¾
¾
¾
Change the LAN IP Address (system will reboot automatically).  
Change the DHCP Settings.  
Change the Wireless configurations.  
Change the Web Management Port.  
Upgrade the firmware of the Router (system will reboot automatically).  
Restore the Router's settings to factory defaults (system will reboot automatically).  
Update the configuration with the file (system will reboot automatically.  
- 189 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
7.9.6 Password  
Choose menu “System Tools Password”, and then you can change the factory default user  
name and password of the Router in the next screen as shown in Figure 7-32.  
Figure 7-32 Password  
It is strongly recommended that you should change the factory default user name and password  
of the Router, because all users who try to access the Router's Web-based utility or Quick Setup  
will be prompted for the Router's default user name and password.  
Note:  
)
The new user name and password must not exceed 14 characters in length and not include any  
spaces. Enter the new Password twice to confirm.  
Click the Save button when finished.  
Click the Clear All button to clear all.  
- 190 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
7.9.7 System Log  
Choose menu “System Tools System Log”, and then you can view the logs of the Router.  
Figure 7-33 System Log  
¾
¾
¾
Refresh - Refresh the page to show the latest log list.  
Save Log - Click to save all the logs in a txt file.  
Mail Log - Click to send an email of current logs manually according to the address and  
validation information set in Mail Settings. The result will be shown in the later log soon.  
¾
Clear Log - All the logs will be deleted from this device permanently, not just from the page.  
- 191 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Chapter 8. Configuration for WISP Client Router Mode  
This chapter will show each Web page's key functions and the configuration way for WISP Client  
Router Mode of TL-WR710N.  
8.1 Login  
After your successful login, you can configure and manage the device. There are main menus on  
the left of the web-based utility. Submenus will be available after you click one of the main menus.  
On the right, there are the corresponding explanations and instructions.  
Figure 8-1  
The detailed explanations for each Web page’s key function are listed below.  
8.2 Status  
The Status page provides the current status information about the Router on WISP Client Router  
Mode. All information is read-only.  
- 192 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure 8-2 Status  
¾
¾
¾
Firmware Version - The version information of the Router’s firmware.  
Hardware Version - The version information of the Router’s hardware.  
LAN - This field displays the current settings or information for the LAN, you can configure  
them in the Network > LAN page.  
MAC Address - The physical address of the Router, as seen from the LAN.  
IP Address - The LAN IP address of the Router.  
- 193 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Subnet Mask - The subnet mask associated with LAN IP address.  
¾
Wireless - This field displays basic information or status for wireless function, you can  
configure them in the Wireless > Wireless Settings page.  
Working Mode - The current wireless working mode in use.  
Wireless Radio - Indicates whether the wireless radio feature of the AP is enabled or  
disabled.  
Name (SSID) - The SSID of the AP.  
Channel - The current wireless channel in use.  
Mode - The current wireless mode which the Router works on.  
Channel Width - The current wireless channel width in use.  
MAC Address - The physical address of the Router, as seen from the WLAN.  
Client Status - The status of Client.  
¾
WAN - This field displays the current settings or information for the WAN, you can configure  
them in the Network > WAN page.  
MAC Address - The physical address of the WAN port, as seen from the Internet.  
IP Address - The current WAN (Internet) IP Address. This field will be blank or 0.0.0.0 if the  
IP Address is assigned dynamically and there is no connection to the Internet.  
Subnet Mask - The subnet mask associated with the WAN IP Address.  
Default Gateway - The Gateway currently used by the Router is shown here. When you  
use Dynamic IP as the connection Internet type, the Renew button will be displayed here.  
Click the Renew Button to obtain new IP parameters dynamically from the ISP. And if you  
have got an IP address, Release button will be displayed here. Click the Release button to  
release the IP address the Router has obtained from the ISP.  
DNS Server - The DNS (Domain Name System) server IP addresses currently used by the  
Router.  
Online Time - The time that you online. When you use PPPoE as WAN connection type,  
the online time is displayed here. Click the Connect or Disconnect button to connect to or  
disconnect from Internet.  
¾
Secondary Connection - Besides PPPoE, if you use an extra connection type to connect to  
a local area network provided by ISP, then parameters of this secondary connection will be  
shown in this area.  
IP Address - The current WAN (Internet) IP Address. This field will be blank or 0.0.0.0 if the  
IP Address is assigned dynamically and there is no connection to the Internet.  
Subnet Mask - The subnet mask associated with the WAN IP Address.  
- 194 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Click the Release to delete the network parameters, and click the Renew button to obtaining  
network parameters.  
¾
Traffic Statistics - The Router’s traffic statistics.  
Received (Bytes) - Traffic that counted in bytes has been received out from the WAN port.  
Received (Packets) - Traffic that counted in packets has been received out from the WAN  
port.  
Sent (Bytes) - Traffic that counted in bytes has been sent out from the WAN port.  
Sent (Packets) - Traffic that counted in packets has been sent out from the WAN port.  
System Up Time - The length of the time since the Router was last powered on or reset.  
¾
Click the Refresh button to get the latest status and settings of the Router.  
8.3 Quick Setup  
8.4 Working Mode  
The Router supports five operation mode types: Wireless Router, Access Point, Repeater,  
Client and Wireless Client Router. Please select one you want. Click Save to save your choice,  
which is shown as Figure 8-3.  
Figure 8-3 Working Mode  
¾
Wireless Router - The wireless Router Mode. In this mode, the device enables multi-user to  
share Internet via DSL/Cable Modem. The only wired port works as WAN.  
¾
¾
¾
Access Point - The wireless access point mode.  
Repeater - The wireless Repeater Mode. It could extend the range of wireless network.  
Client - The Client Mode. The computer connected by Ethernet could get access to an AP by  
Client mode.  
- 195 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
¾
WISP Client Router - In this mode, the device enables multiple users to share Internet  
connection from WISP.  
8.5 Network  
Figure 8-4 The Network menu  
There are three submenus under the Network menu (shown in Figure 8-4): WAN, MAC Clone  
and LAN. Click any of them, and you will be able to configure the corresponding function.  
8.5.1 WAN  
Choose menu “Network WAN”, and then you can configure the IP parameters of the WAN on  
the screen below.  
1. If your ISP provides the DHCP service, please choose Dynamic IP type, and the Router will  
automatically get IP parameters from your ISP. You can see the page as follow (Figure 8-5):  
Figure 8-5 WAN – Dynamic IP  
This page displays the WAN IP parameters assigned dynamically by your ISP, including IP  
address, Subnet Mask, Default Gateway, etc. Click the Renew button to renew the IP  
parameters from your ISP. Click the Release button to release the IP parameters.  
- 196 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
¾
MTU Size - The normal MTU (Maximum Transmission Unit) value for most Ethernet networks  
is 1500 Bytes. It is not recommended that you change the default MTU Size unless required  
by your ISP.  
¾
Use These DNS Servers - If your ISP gives you one or two DNS addresses, select Use  
These DNS Servers and enter the primary and secondary addresses into the correct fields.  
Otherwise, the DNS servers will be assigned dynamically from your ISP.  
Note:  
)
If you find error when you go to a website after entering the DNS addresses, it is likely that your  
DNS servers are set up improperly. You should contact your ISP to get DNS server addresses.  
¾
¾
Host Name - This option specifies the Host Name of the Router.  
Get IP with Unicast DHCP - A few ISPs' DHCP servers do not support the broadcast  
applications. If you cannot get the IP Address normally, you can choose this option. (It is  
rarely required.)  
Click the Save button to save your settings.  
2. If your ISP provides a static or fixed IP Address, Subnet Mask, Default Gateway and DNS  
setting, select Static IP. The Static IP settings page will appear as shown in Figure 8-6.  
Figure 8-6 WAN - Static IP  
¾
¾
IP Address - Enter the IP address in dotted-decimal notation provided by your ISP.  
Subnet Mask - Enter the subnet Mask in dotted-decimal notation provided by your ISP,  
usually is 255.255.255.0.  
¾
Default Gateway - Enter the gateway IP address in dotted-decimal notation provided by  
your ISP.  
- 197 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
¾
¾
MTU Size - The normal MTU (Maximum Transmission Unit) value for most Ethernet  
networks is 1500 Bytes. It is not recommended that you change the default MTU Size  
unless required by your ISP.  
Primary/Secondary DNS - (Optional) Enter one or two DNS addresses in  
dotted-decimal notation provided by your ISP.  
Click the Save button to save your settings.  
3. If your ISP provides a PPPoE connection, select PPPoE/Russia PPPoE option. Then you  
should enter the following parameters (Figure 8-7):  
Figure 8-7 WAN – PPPoE/Russia PPPoE  
¾
¾
¾
User Name/Password - Enter the User Name and Password provided by your ISP.  
These fields are case-sensitive.  
Confirm Password - Enter again the Password provided by your ISP to ensure the  
password you entered is correct.  
Secondary Connection - It’s available only for PPPoE Connection. If your ISP provides  
an extra Connection type such as Dynamic/Static IP to connect to a local area network,  
then you can check the radio button of Dynamic/Static IP to activate this secondary  
connection.  
Disabled - The Secondary Connection is disabled by default, so there is PPPoE  
connection only. This is recommended.  
- 198 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Dynamic IP - You can check this radio button to use Dynamic IP as the secondary  
connection to connect to the local area network provided by ISP.  
Static IP - You can check this radio button to use Static IP as the secondary  
connection to connect to the local area network provided by ISP.  
¾
Connect on Demand - In this mode, the Internet connection can be terminated  
automatically after a specified inactivity period (Max Idle Time) and be re-established  
when you attempt to access the Internet again. If you want your Internet connection  
keeps active all the time, please enter “0” in the Max Idle Time field. Otherwise, enter  
the number of minutes you want to have elapsed before your Internet access  
disconnects.  
¾
¾
Connect Automatically - The connection can be re-established automatically when it  
was down.  
Time-based Connecting - The connection will only be established in the period from the  
start time to the end time (both are in HH:MM format).  
Note:  
)
Only when you have configured the system time on “System Tools Time” page, will  
the Time-based Connecting function can take effect.  
¾
Connect Manually  
-
You can click the Connect/Disconnect button to  
connect/disconnect immediately. This mode also supports the Max Idle Time function as  
Connect on Demand mode. The Internet connection can be disconnected automatically  
after a specified inactivity period and re-established when you attempt to access the  
Internet again.  
Click the Connect button to connect immediately. Click the Disconnect button to disconnect  
immediately.  
Caution: Sometimes the connection cannot be terminated although you specify a time to  
Max Idle Time because some applications are visiting the Internet continually in the  
background.  
If you want to do some advanced configurations, please click the Advanced button, and the  
- 199 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure 8-8 PPPoE Advanced Settings  
¾
¾
MTU Size - The default MTU size is “1480” bytes, which is usually fine. It is not  
recommended that you change the default MTU Size unless required by your ISP.  
Service Name/AC Name - The service name and AC (Access Concentrator) name  
should not be configured unless you are sure it is necessary for your ISP. In most cases,  
leaving these fields blank will work.  
¾
¾
ISP Specified IP Address - If your ISP does not automatically assign IP addresses to  
the Router during login, please click “Use IP address specified by ISP” check box and  
enter the IP address provided by your ISP in dotted-decimal notation.  
Detect Online Interval - The Router will detect Access Concentrator online at every  
interval. The default value is “0”. You can input the value between “0” and “120”. The  
value “0” means no detect.  
¾
Primary DNS/Secondary DNS - If your ISP does not automatically assign DNS  
addresses to the Router during login, please click “Use the following DNS servers”  
check box and enter the IP address in dotted-decimal notation of your ISP’s primary  
DNS server. If a secondary DNS server address is available, enter it as well.  
Click the Save button to save your settings.  
4. If your ISP provides BigPond Cable connection, please select BigPond Cable option. Then  
you should enter the following parameters (Figure 8-9):  
- 200 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure 8-9 WAN – BigPond Cable  
¾
User Name/Password - Enter the User Name and Password provided by your ISP.  
These fields are case-sensitive.  
¾
¾
¾
Auth Server - Enter the authenticating server IP address or host name.  
Auth Domain - Type in the domain suffix server name based on your location,  
MTU Size - The default MTU size is “1480” bytes, which is usually fine. It is not  
recommended that you change the default MTU Size unless required by your ISP.  
¾
Connect on Demand - In this mode, the Internet connection can be terminated  
automatically after a specified inactivity period (Max Idle Time) and be re-established  
when you attempt to access the Internet again. If you want your Internet connection  
keeps active all the time, please enter “0” in the Max Idle Time field. Otherwise, enter  
the number of minutes you want to have elapsed before your Internet access  
disconnects.  
¾
¾
Connect Automatically - The connection can be re-established automatically when it  
was down.  
Connect Manually  
-
You can click the Connect/Disconnect button to  
connect/disconnect immediately. This mode also supports the Max Idle Time function as  
Connect on Demand mode. The Internet connection can be disconnected automatically  
- 201 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
after a specified inactivity period and re-established when you attempt to access the  
Internet again.  
Click the Connect button to connect immediately. Click the Disconnect button to disconnect  
immediately.  
Caution: Sometimes the connection cannot be terminated although you specify a time to  
Max Idle Time because some applications are visiting the Internet continually in the  
background.  
Click the Save button to save your settings.  
5. If your ISP provides L2TP connection, please select L2TP/Russia L2TP option. Then you  
should enter the following parameters (Figure 8-10):  
Figure 8-10 WAN – L2TP/Russia L2TP  
¾
¾
User Name/Password - Enter the User Name and Password provided by your ISP.  
These fields are case-sensitive.  
Dynamic IP/ Static IP - Choose either as you are given by your ISP. Click the Connect  
button to connect immediately. Click the Disconnect button to disconnect immediately.  
- 202 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
¾
Connect on Demand - You can configure the Router to disconnect from your Internet  
connection after a specified period of inactivity (Max Idle Time). If your Internet  
connection has been terminated due to inactivity, Connect on Demand enables the  
Router to automatically re-establish your connection as soon as you attempt to access  
the Internet again. If you wish to activate Connect on Demand, check the radio button.  
If you want your Internet connection to remain active at all times, enter 0 in the Max Idle  
Time field. Otherwise, enter the number of minutes you want to have elapsed before  
your Internet connection terminates.  
¾
¾
Connect Automatically - Connect automatically after the Router is disconnected. To  
use this option, check the radio button.  
Connect Manually - You can configure the Router to make it connect or disconnect  
manually. After a specified period of inactivity (Max Idle Time), the Router will  
disconnect from your Internet connection, and you will not be able to re-establish your  
connection automatically as soon as you attempt to access the Internet again. To use  
this option, check the radio button. If you want your Internet connection to remain active  
at all times, enter "0" in the Max Idle Time field. Otherwise, enter the number of minutes  
that you wish to have the Internet connecting last unless a new link is requested.  
Caution: Sometimes the connection cannot be disconnected although you specify a time to  
Max Idle Time, because some applications are visiting the Internet continually in the  
background.  
Click the Save button to save your settings.  
- 203 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
6. If your ISP provides PPTP connection, please select PPTP/Russia PPTP option. And you  
should enter the following parameters (Figure 8-11):  
Figure 8-11 WAN – PPTP/Russia PPTP  
¾
¾
User Name/Password - Enter the User Name and Password provided by your ISP.  
These fields are case-sensitive.  
Dynamic IP/ Static IP - Choose either as you are given by your ISP and enter the ISP’s  
IP address or the domain name.  
If you choose static IP and enter the domain name, you should also enter the DNS  
assigned by your ISP. And click the Save button.  
Click the Connect button to connect immediately. Click the Disconnect button to  
disconnect immediately.  
¾
Connect on Demand - You can configure the Router to disconnect from your Internet  
connection after a specified period of inactivity (Max Idle Time). If your Internet  
connection has been terminated due to inactivity, Connect on Demand enables the  
Router to automatically re-establish your connection as soon as you attempt to access  
- 204 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
the Internet again. If you wish to activate Connect on Demand, check the radio button.  
If you want your Internet connection to remain active at all times, enter “0” in the Max  
Idle Time field. Otherwise, enter the number of minutes you want to have elapsed before  
your Internet connection terminates.  
¾
¾
Connect Automatically - Connect automatically after the Router is disconnected. To  
use this option, check the radio button.  
Connect Manually - You can configure the Router to make it connect or disconnect  
manually. After a specified period of inactivity (Max Idle Time), the Router will  
disconnect from your Internet connection, and you will not be able to re-establish your  
connection automatically as soon as you attempt to access the Internet again. To use  
this option, click the radio button. If you want your Internet connection to remain active at  
all times, enter "0" in the Max Idle Time field. Otherwise, enter the number in minutes  
that you wish to have the Internet connecting last unless a new link is requested.  
Caution: Sometimes the connection cannot be disconnected although you specify a time to  
Max Idle Time because some applications are visiting the Internet continually in the  
background.  
Click the Save button to save your settings.  
8.5.2 MAC Clone  
Choose menu “Network MAC Clone”, and then you can configure the WAN MAC address  
on the screen below, as shown in Figure 8-12:  
Figure 8-12 MAC Address Clone  
Some ISPs require that you register the MAC Address of your adapter. Changes are rarely  
needed here.  
¾
WAN MAC Address - This field displays the current MAC address of the WAN port. If your  
ISP requires you to register the MAC address, please enter the correct MAC address into  
this field in XX-XX-XX-XX-XX-XX format (X is any hexadecimal digit).  
¾
Your PC's MAC Address - This field displays the MAC address of the PC that is managing  
the Router. If the MAC address is required, you can click the Clone MAC Address To  
button and this MAC address will fill in the WAN MAC Address field.  
- 205 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Click Restore Factory MAC to restore the MAC address of WAN port to the factory default  
value.  
Click the Save button to save your settings.  
Note:  
)
1. Only the PC on your LAN can use the MAC Address Clone function.  
2. If you change WAN MAC Address when the WAN connection is PPPoE, it will not take effect  
until the connection is re-established.  
8.5.3 LAN  
Choose menu “Network LAN”, and then you can configure the IP parameters of the LAN on  
the screen as below.  
Figure 8-13 LAN  
¾
¾
¾
¾
MAC Address - The physical address of the LAN ports, as seen from the LAN. The value  
can't be changed.  
IP Address - Enter the IP address of your Router in dotted-decimal notation (factory default:  
192.168.0.254).  
Subnet Mask - An address code that determines the size of the network. Normally use  
255.255.255.0 as the subnet mask.  
IGMP Proxy - The Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) feature allows your devices  
in LAN can watch TV.  
Note:  
)
1. If you change the IP Address of LAN, you must use the new IP Address to login to the Router.  
2. If the new LAN IP Address you set is not in the same subnet with the previous one, the IP  
Address pool in the DHCP server will be configured automaticallywhile the Virtual Server and  
DMZ Host will not take effect until they are re-configured.  
- 206 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
8.6 Wireless  
Figure 8-14 Wireless menu  
There are five submenus under the Wireless menu (shown in Figure 8-14): Wireless Settings,  
Wireless Security, Wireless MAC Filtering, Wireless Advanced and Wireless Statistics. Click  
any of them, and you will be able to configure the corresponding function.  
8.6.1 Wireless Settings  
Choose menu “Wireless Wireless Settings”, and then you can configure the basic settings  
for the wireless network on this page.  
Figure 8-15 Wireless Security  
¾
¾
¾
SSID - The SSID of the AP your Router is going to connect to as a client.  
BSSID - The BSSID of the AP your Router is going to connect to as a client.  
Survey - Click this button to search the APs.  
- 207 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
¾
¾
¾
¾
¾
¾
Key type - Choose according to the AP's security configuration. It is recommended that the  
security type is the same as your AP's security type  
WEP Index - Choose if the key type is WEP (ASCII) or WEP (HEX).It indicates the index of  
the WEP key.  
Auth Type - Choose if the key type is WEP (ASCII) or WEP (HEX).It indicates the  
authorization type of the Root AP.  
Password - Fill the password in this blank if the AP your Router is going to connect needs  
password.  
Local SSID - Enter a value of up to 32 characters. The same Name (SSID) must be assigned  
to all wireless devices in your network.  
Enable Wireless Router Radio - The wireless radio of the Router can be enabled or  
disabled to allow wireless stations access. If enabled, the wireless stations will be able to  
access the Router. Otherwise, wireless stations will not be able to access the Router.  
¾
¾
Enable SSID Broadcast - If you select the Enable SSID Broadcast checkbox, the wireless  
router will broadcast its name (SSID) on the air.  
Disable Local Wireless Access - If you select the Disable Local Wireless Access checkbox,  
the wireless router will disable local wireless access, other stations will not be able to access  
the Router by wireless.  
- 208 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
8.6.2 Wireless Security  
Figure 8-16 Wireless Security  
¾
¾
Disable Security - The wireless security function can be enabled or disabled. If disabled, the  
wireless stations will be able to connect the Router without encryption. But it’s strongly  
recommended to choose one of the following modes to enable security.  
WPA-PSK/WPA2-Personal - It’s the WPA/WPA2 authentication type based on pre-shared  
passphrase.  
Version - you can choose the version of the WPA-PSK security on the drop-down list. The  
default setting is Automatic, which can select WPA-PSK (Pre-shared key of WPA) or  
WPA2-PSK (Pre-shared key of WPA) automatically based on the wireless station's  
capability and request.  
Encryption - When WPA-PSK or WPA is set as the Authentication Type, you can select  
either Automatic, or TKIP or AES as Encryption.  
- 209 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Note:  
)
If you check the WPA/WPA2-Personal radio button and choose TKIP encryption, you will find  
a notice in red as shown in Figure 8-17.  
Figure 8-17  
¾
WPA /WPA2-Enterprise - It’s based on Radius Server.  
Version - you can choose the version of the WPA security from the pull-down list. The  
default setting is Automatic, which can select WPA (Wi-Fi Protected Access) or WPA2  
(WPA version 2) automatically based on the wireless station's capability and request.  
Encryption - You can select Automatic, TKIP or AES.  
Radius Server IP - Enter the IP address of the Radius server.  
Radius Port - Enter the port that Radius server used.  
Radius Password - Enter the password for the Radius server.  
Group Key Update Period - Specify the group key update interval in seconds. The value  
should be 30 or above. Enter 0 to disable the update.  
¾
WEP - It is based on the IEEE 802.11 standard.  
Type - you can choose the type for the WEP security on the pull-down list. The default  
setting is Automatic, which can select Shared Key or Open System authentication type  
automatically based on the wireless station's capability and request.  
WEP Key Format - Hexadecimal and ASCII formats are provided here. Hexadecimal  
format stands for any combination of hexadecimal digits (0-9, a-f, A-F) in the specified  
length. ASCII format stands for any combination of keyboard characters in the specified  
length.  
WEP Key (Password) - Select which of the four keys will be used and enter the matching  
WEP key that you create. Make sure these values are identical on all wireless stations in  
your network.  
Key Type - You can select the WEP key length (64-bit, or 128-bit, or 152-bit.) for  
encryption. "Disabled" means this WEP key entry is invalid.  
- 210 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
64-bit - You can enter 10 hexadecimal digits (any combination of 0-9, a-f, A-F, zero key is  
not promoted) or 5 ASCII characters.  
128-bit - You can enter 26 hexadecimal digits (any combination of 0-9, a-f, A-F, zero key is  
not promoted) or 13 ASCII characters.  
152-bit - You can enter 32 hexadecimal digits (any combination of 0-9, a-f, A-F, zero key is  
not promoted) or 16 ASCII characters.  
Note:  
)
If you do not set the key, the wireless security function is still disabled even if you have selected  
Shared Key as Authentication Type.  
Be sure to click the Save button to save your settings on this page.  
8.6.3 Wireless MAC Filtering  
Choose menu “Wireless Wireless MAC Filtering”, and then you can control the wireless  
access by configuring the Wireless MAC Filtering function, as shown in Figure 8-18.  
Figure 8-18 Wireless MAC Filtering  
To filter wireless users by MAC Address, click Enable. The default setting is Disabled.  
¾
¾
¾
MAC Address - The wireless station's MAC address that you want to access.  
Status - The status of this entry, either Enabled or Disabled.  
Description - A simple description of the wireless station.  
To Add a Wireless MAC Address filtering entry, click the Add New… button. The "Add or Modify  
Wireless MAC Address Filtering entry" page will appear, shown in Figure 8-19:  
- 211 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure 8-19 Add or Modify Wireless MAC Address Filtering entry  
To add or modify a MAC Address Filtering entry, follow these instructions:  
1. Enter the appropriate MAC Address into the MAC Address field. The format of the MAC  
Address is XX-XX-XX-XX-XX-XX (X is any hexadecimal digit). For example:  
00-0A-EB-B0-00-0B.  
2. Give a simple description for the wireless station in the Description field. For example:  
Wireless station A.  
3. Select Enabled or Disabled for this entry on the Status pull-down list.  
4. Click the Save button to save this entry.  
To modify or delete an existing entry:  
1. Click the Modify in the entry you want to modify. If you want to delete the entry, click the  
Delete.  
2. Modify the information.  
3. Click the Save button.  
Click the Enable All button to make all entries enabled  
Click the Disable All button to make all entries disabled.  
Click the Delete All button to delete all entries.  
Click the Next button to go to the next page.  
Click the Previous button to return to the previous page.  
For example: If you desire that the wireless station A with MAC address 00-0A-EB-B0-00-0B and  
the wireless station B with MAC address 00-0A-EB-00-07-5F are able to access the Router, but all  
the other wireless stations cannot access the Router, you can configure the Wireless MAC  
Address Filtering list by following these steps:  
1. Click the Enable button to enable this function.  
2. Select the radio button “Allow the stations specified by any enabled entries in the list to  
access” for Filtering Rules.  
3. Delete all or disable all entries if there are any entries already.  
- 212 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
4. Click the Add New... button.  
1) Enter the MAC address 00-0A-EB-B0-00-0B/00-0A-EB-00-07-5F in the MAC Address field.  
2) Enter wireless station A/B in the Description field.  
3) Select Enabled in the Status pull-down list.  
4) Click the Save button.  
5) Click the Back button.  
The filtering rules that configured should be similar to the following list:  
Figure 8-20 Filtering Rules  
8.6.4 Wireless Advanced  
Choose menu “Wireless Wireless Advanced”, and then you can configure the advanced  
settings of your wireless network.  
Figure 8-21 Wireless Advanced  
¾
¾
Transmit Power - Here you can specify the transmit power of Router. You can select High,  
Middle or Low which you would like. High is the default setting and is recommended.  
Beacon Interval - Enter a value between 20-1000 milliseconds for Beacon Interval here.  
The beacons are the packets sent by the Router to synchronize a wireless network. Beacon  
Interval value determines the time interval of the beacons. The default value is 100.  
¾
RTS Threshold - Here you can specify the RTS (Request to Send) Threshold. If the packet  
is larger than the specified RTS Threshold size, the Router will send RTS frames to a  
- 213 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
particular receiving station and negotiate the sending of a data frame. The default value is  
2346.  
¾
¾
Fragmentation Threshold - This value is the maximum size determining whether packets  
will be fragmented. Setting the Fragmentation Threshold too low may result in poor network  
performance because of excessive packets. 2346 is the default setting and is  
recommended.  
DTIM Interval - This value determines the interval of the Delivery Traffic Indication Message  
(DTIM). A DTIM field is a countdown field informing clients of the next window for listening to  
broadcast and multicast messages. When the Router has buffered broadcast or multicast  
messages for associated clients, it sends the next DTIM with a DTIM Interval value. You can  
specify the value between 1-255 Beacon Intervals. The default value is 1, which indicates  
the DTIM Interval is the same as Beacon Interval.  
¾
¾
¾
Enable WMM - WMM function can guarantee the packets with high-priority messages being  
transmitted preferentially. It is strongly recommended enabled.  
Enable Short GI - This function is recommended for it will increase the data capacity by  
reducing the guard interval time.  
Enable AP Isolation - This function isolate all connected wireless stations so that wireless  
stations cannot access each other through WLAN. This function will be disabled if  
WDS/Bridge is enabled.  
Note:  
)
If you are not familiar with the setting items in this page, it's strongly recommended to keep the  
provided default values; otherwise it may result in lower wireless network performance.  
8.6.5 Wireless Statistics  
Choose menu “Wireless Wireless Statistics”, and then you can see the MAC Address,  
Current Status, Received Packets and Sent Packets for each connected wireless station.  
Figure 8-22 Wireless Statistics  
¾
MAC Address - The connected wireless station's MAC address  
- 214 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
¾
Current Status - The connected wireless station's running status, one of STA-AUTH /  
STA-ASSOC / STA-JOINED / WPA / WPA-PSK / WPA2 / WPA2-PSK / AP-UP / AP-DOWN /  
Disconnected  
¾
¾
¾
Received Packets - Packets received by the station  
Sent Packets - Packets sent by the station.  
Configure - The button is used for loading the item to the Wireless MAC Filtering list.  
Allow - If the Wireless MAC Filtering function enable, allow the station to access.  
Deny - If the Wireless MAC Filtering function enable, deny the station to access.  
You cannot change any of the values on this page. To update this page and to show the current  
connected wireless stations, click on the Refresh button.  
If the numbers of connected wireless stations go beyond one page, click the Next button to go to  
the next page and click the Previous button to return the previous page.  
Note:  
)
This page will be refreshed automatically every 5 seconds.  
8.7 DHCP  
Figure 8-23 The DHCP menu  
There are three submenus under the DHCP menu (shown in Figure 8-23): DHCP Settings,  
DHCP Client List and Address Reservation. Click any of them, and you will be able to configure  
the corresponding function.  
8.7.1 DHCP Settings  
Choose menu “DHCP DHCP Settings”, and then you can configure the DHCP Server on the  
page as shown in Figure 8-24. The Router is set up by default as a DHCP (Dynamic Host  
Configuration Protocol) server, which provides the TCP/IP configuration for all the PC(s) that are  
connected to the Router in the LAN.  
- 215 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure 8-24 DHCP Settings  
¾
DHCP Server - Enable or Disable the DHCP server. If you disable the Server, you must  
have another DHCP server within your network or else you must configure the computer  
manually.  
¾
¾
¾
Start IP Address - Specify an IP address for the DHCP Server to start with when assigning  
IP addresses. 192.168.0.100 is the default start address.  
End IP Address - Specify an IP address for the DHCP Server to end with when assigning IP  
addresses. 192.168.0.199 is the default end address.  
Address Lease Time - The Address Lease Time is the amount of time a network user will  
be allowed connection to the Router with their current dynamic IP Address. Enter the  
amount of time in minutes and the user will be "leased" this dynamic IP Address. After the  
time is up, the user will be automatically assigned a new dynamic IP address. The range of  
the time is 1 ~ 2880 minutes. The default value is 120 minutes.  
¾
Default Gateway (Optional) - It is suggested to input the IP address of the LAN port of the  
Router. The default value is 192.168.0.254.  
¾
¾
Default Domain (Optional) - Input the domain name of your network.  
Primary DNS - (Optional) Input the DNS IP address provided by your ISP or consult your  
ISP. Or consult your ISP.  
¾
Secondary DNS (Optional) - Input the IP address of another DNS server if your ISP  
provides two DNS servers.  
Note:  
)
To use the DHCP server function of the Router, you must configure all computers on the LAN as  
"Obtain an IP Address automatically".  
- 216 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
8.7.2 DHCP Client List  
Choose menu “DHCP DHCP Client List”, and then you can view the information about the  
clients attached to the Router in the screen as shown in Figure 8-25.  
Figure 8-25 DHCP Client List  
¾
¾
¾
¾
Client Name - The name of the DHCP client  
MAC Address - The MAC address of the DHCP client  
Assigned IP - The IP address that the Router has allocated to the DHCP client  
Lease Time - The time of the DHCP client leased. After the dynamic IP address has expired,  
a new dynamic IP address will be automatically assigned to the user.  
You cannot change any of the values on this page. To update this page and to show the current  
attached devices, click the Refresh button.  
8.7.3 Address Reservation  
Choose menu “DHCP Address Reservation”, and then you can view and add a reserved  
address for clients via the next screen (shown in Figure 8-26).When you specify a reserved IP  
address for a PC on the LAN, that PC will always receive the same IP address each time when it  
accesses the DHCP server. Reserved IP addresses should be assigned to the servers that  
require permanent IP settings.  
Figure 8-26 Address Reservation  
¾
¾
¾
MAC Address - The MAC address of the PC for which you want to reserve an IP address.  
Reserved IP Address - The IP address reserved for the PC by the Router.  
Status - The status of this entry, either Enabled or Disabled.  
- 217 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Modify - To modify or delete an existing entry.  
To Reserve an IP address:  
¾
1. Click the Add New… button. Then will pop-up.  
2. Enter the MAC address (in XX-XX-XX-XX-XX-XX format.) and IP address (in dotted-decimal  
notation) of the computer for which you want to reserve an IP address.  
3. Click the Save button.  
Figure 8-27 Add or Modify an Address Reservation Entry  
To modify or delete an existing entry:  
1. Click the Modify in the entry you want to modify. If you want to delete the entry, click the  
Delete.  
2. Modify the information.  
3. Click the Save button.  
Click the Enable/Disable All button to make all entries enabled/disabled.  
Click the Delete All button to delete all entries.  
Click the Next button to go to the next page and Click the Previous button to return the  
previous page.  
8.8 USB Settings  
Figure 8-28 The USB Settings menu  
There are three submenus under the USB Settings menu (shown in Figure 8-28), Storage  
Sharing, Media Server and User Accounts. Click any of them, and you will be able to configure  
the corresponding functions.  
- 218 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
8.8.1 Storage Sharing  
Choose menu “USB SettingsStorage Sharing”, you can configure a USB disk drive attached  
to the router and view volume and share such properties as share name, capacity, used space,  
and free space on this page as shown below.  
Figure 8-29 Storage Sharing  
¾
¾
Service Status - Indicates the Network Sharing service's current status. You can click the  
Start button to start the Storage Sharing service and click the Stop button to stop it.  
Volume - The volume name of the USB drive the users have access to. Volume 1-8 is  
mapping to USB port1, and Volume 9-16 is mapping to USB port2.  
¾
¾
¾
¾
¾
Capacity - The storage capacity of the USB driver.  
Used - The used space of the USB driver.  
Free - The available space of the USB driver.  
Use% - The percentage of the used space.  
Shared - Indicates the shared or non-shared status of the volume. When the volume is  
shared, you can click the Disable to stop sharing the volume; when volume is non-shared,  
you can click the Enable button to share the volume.  
Click the Start button to start the Network Sharing service.  
Click the Stop button to stop the Network Sharing service.  
Click the Eject Disk button to safely remove the USB storage device that is connected to USB  
port. This takes the drive offline. A message (as shown in Figure 8-30) will appear on your web  
browser when it is safe to detach the USB disk.  
- 219 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure 8-30 Safe Unplug Message  
Click the Rescan button to start a new scan.  
Follow the instructions below to set up your router as a file server:  
1. Plug an external USB hard disk drive or USB flash drive into this router.  
2. Click the Rescan button to find the USB drive that has been attached to the router.  
3. Click the Start button to start the Storage Sharing service.  
4. Click the Enable button under Shared to enable the disk to share.  
5. Click the Open the disk to visit the sharing disk.  
Note:  
)
1. The router can automatically locate new USB drive. But to display the information about your  
USB device, you need to click the Rescan button manually.  
2. The new settings will not take effect until you restart the service.  
3. To unplug the USB drive, click Eject Disk button first. Simply pulling USB drive out of the  
USB port can cause damage to the device and loss of data.  
4. Mounted volumes of each USB port are subject to the 8-volume limit. So you cannot access  
more than 8 volumes on the USB storage device.  
5. If you change the storage settings during the storage connection is established, then the  
changes will not take effect until the router or the client is rebooted.  
8.8.2 Media Server  
Choose menu “USB SettingsMedia Server”, you can create media server that allows you to  
share stored content with other computers and devices on your home network and on the Internet.  
- 220 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure 8-31 Media Server Setting  
¾
¾
Server Name - The name of this Media Server.  
Server Status - Indicates the Media Server’s current status, started or stopped. You can  
click the Start button to start the Media Server and click the Stop button to stop it.  
Name - The display name of this folder.  
¾
¾
¾
¾
File System - The file system type on the partition can be FAT32 or NTFS.  
Folder - The real full path of the specified folder.  
Delete - You can delete the share folder by click Delete.  
To set up your media server, please follow the instructions below:  
1. Plug an external USB hard disk drive or USB flash drive into this router, and then the screen  
will appear as shown in Figure 8-32.  
Figure 8-32 Media Server Setting  
2. Click the Start button to start the media server, and then the screen will appear as shown in  
Figure 8-33 Media Server Setting  
- 221 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
3. Click the Add share folder button to specify a folder as the search path of media server. The  
screen will then appear as shown in Figure 8-34.  
Figure 8-34 Add New Folder  
¾
¾
Display Name - You can enter a display name for the share folder.  
Share entire partition - Choose this option and then the folders contained in this  
partition will all be shared.  
¾
¾
¾
¾
¾
Folder Location- Displays the location of this folder.  
Select - Check the radio button to select the folder to share.  
Folder - Displays folders that are in current path.  
Upper - Click this button to get into the upper folder.  
Save - Click this button to save your settings and the page will be redirected to the  
media server configuration page.  
¾
Back - Click this button to discard the settings and just go to the media server  
configuration page.  
4. Click the Scan All button to scan all the share folders immediately. You can also select the  
Auto-scan, at same time, select an auto scan interval time by drop-down list. In this case, the  
media server will auto scan the share folders.  
Note:  
)
The max share folders number is 6. If you want share a new folder when the number has been  
reached to be 6, you can delete a share folder and then add a new one.  
8.8.3 User Accounts  
You can specify the user name and password for Storage Sharing users on this page. Storage  
Sharing users can use Internet Explorer to access files on the USB drive.  
- 222 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
There are two default user accounts that can access the Storage Sharing. They are Administrator  
and Guest (as shown in Figure 8-35). Administrator has read/write access to Storage Sharing and  
can access FTP Server while Guest has read-only access to Storage Sharing and cannot access  
FTP Server.  
Figure 8-35 User Account Management  
Only Administrator can use a Web browser to transfer the files from a PC to the Writable shared  
volume on the USB drive.  
To add a new user account, please follow the steps below:  
1. Click Add New User button, and the screen will appear as shown in Figure 8-35.  
2. Self-define a User Name.  
3. Enter the password in the Password field.  
4. Choose the Storage Authority from the drop-down list, Read and Write or Read Only.  
Figure 8-36 Add or Modify User Account  
¾
¾
User Name - Type the user name that you want to give access to the USB drive. The user  
name must be composed of alphanumeric symbols not exceeding 15 characters in length.  
Password - Enter the password in the Password field. The password must be composed of  
alphanumeric symbols not exceeding 15 characters in length. For security purposes, the  
password for each user account is not displayed.  
- 223 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
¾
Storage Authority – Choose Read and Write or Read Only from the drop-down list to  
assign access authority of Storage Sharing to the user.  
¾
¾
Save - You can click the Save button to save your settings.  
Back - You can click the Back button to discard the settings and just go to the media server  
configuration page.  
Note:  
)
Please restart the service for the new settings to take effect.  
If you cannot use the new user name and password to access the shares, press Windows logo +  
R to open the Run dialog box and type net use \\192.168.0.254 /delete /yes and press Enter.  
(192.168.0.254 is your router's LAN IP address. If the LAN IP of the modem connected with your  
router is 192.168.1.x, the default LAN IP of the router will automatically switch from 192.168.0.254  
to 192.168.1.254 to avoid IP conflict; in this case, please try net use \\192.168.1.254 /delete /  
yes.)  
8.9 Forwarding  
Figure 8-37 The Forwarding menu  
There are four submenus under the Forwarding menu (shown in Figure 8-37): Virtual Servers,  
Port Triggering, DMZ and UPnP. Click any of them, and you will be able to configure the  
corresponding function.  
8.9.1 Virtual Servers  
Choose menu “Forwarding Virtual Servers”, and then you can view and add virtual servers  
in the screen as shown in Figure 8-38. Virtual servers can be used for setting up public services  
on your LAN, such as DNS, Email and FTP. A virtual server is defined as a service port, and all  
requests from the Internet to this service port will be redirected to the computer specified by the  
server IP. Any PC that was used for a virtual server must have a static or reserved IP Address  
because its IP Address may be changed when using the DHCP function.  
- 224 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure 8-38 Virtual Servers  
¾
¾
Service Port - The numbers of External Ports. You can type a service port or a range of  
service ports (in XXX – YYY format, XXX is the start port number, YYY is the end port  
number).  
Internal Port - The Internal Service Port number of the PC running the service application.  
You can leave it blank if the Internal Port is the same as the Service Port, or enter a  
specific port number when Service Port is a single one.  
¾
¾
IP Address - The IP Address of the PC providing the service application.  
Protocol - The protocol used for this application, either TCP, UDP, or All (all protocols  
supported by the Router).  
¾
¾
Status - The status of this entry, either Enabled or Disabled.  
Modify - To modify or delete an existing entry.  
To setup a virtual server entry:  
1. Click the Add New… button, the next screen will pop-up as shown in Figure 8-38.  
2. Select the service port you want to use from the Common Service Port list. If the Common  
Service Port list does not have the service that you want to use, type the service port  
number or service port range in the Service Port box.  
3. Type the IP Address of the computer in the IP Address box.  
4. Select the protocol used for this application, either TCP, UDP, or All.  
5. Select the Enable to enable the virtual server.  
6. Click the Save button.  
- 225 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure 8-39 Add or Modify a Virtual Server Entry  
Note:  
)
If your computer or server has more than one type of available service, please select another  
service, and enter the same IP Address for that computer or server.  
To modify or delete an existing entry:  
1. Click the Modify in the entry you want to modify. If you want to delete the entry, click the  
Delete.  
2. Modify the information.  
3. Click the Save button.  
Click the Enable/Disable All button to make all entries enabled/disabled.  
Click the Delete All button to delete all entries.  
Click the Next button to go to the next page and click the Previous button to return the previous  
page.  
Note:  
)
If you set the service port of the virtual server as 80, you must set the Web management port on  
Security Remote Management” page to be any other value except 80 such as 8080.  
Otherwise there will be a conflict to disable the virtual server.  
8.9.2 Port Triggering  
Choose menu “Forwarding Port Triggering”, and then you can view and add port triggering  
in the screen as shown in Figure 8-40. Some applications require multiple connections, like  
Internet games, video conferencing, Internet calling and so on. These applications cannot work  
with a pure NAT Router. Port Triggering is used for some of these applications that can work with  
an NAT Router.  
- 226 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure 8-40 Port Triggering  
Once the Router is configured, the operation is as follows:  
1. A local host makes an outgoing connection using a destination port number defined in the  
Trigger Port field.  
2. The Router records this connection, opens the incoming port or ports associated with this  
entry in the Port Triggering table, and associates them with the local host.  
3. When necessarythe external host will be able to connect to the local host using one of the  
ports defined in the Incoming Ports field.  
¾
Trigger Port - The port for outgoing traffic. An outgoing connection using this port will trigger  
this rule.  
¾
¾
Trigger Protocol - The protocol used for Trigger Ports, either TCP, UDP, or All (all  
protocols supported by the Router).  
Incoming Ports - The port or port range used by the remote system when it responds to the  
outgoing request. A response using one of these ports will be forwarded to the PC that  
triggered this rule. You can input at most 5 groups of ports (or port sections). Every group of  
ports must be set apart with ",". For example, 2000-2038, 2050-2051, 2085, 3010-3030.  
¾
Incoming Protocol - The protocol used for Incoming Ports Range, either TCP or UDP, or  
ALL (all protocols supported by the Router).  
¾
¾
Status - The status of this entry, either Enabled or Disabled.  
Modify - To modify or delete an existing entry.  
To add a new rule, follow the steps below:  
1. Click the Add New… button, the next screen will pop-up as shown in Figure 8-40.  
2. Select a common application from the Common Applications drop-down list, then the  
Trigger Port field and the Incoming Ports field will be automatically filled. If the Common  
Applications do not have the application you need, enter the Trigger Port and the  
Incoming Ports manually.  
3. Select the protocol used for Trigger Port from the Trigger Protocol drop-down list, either  
TCP, UDP, or All.  
4. Select the protocol used for Incoming Ports from the Incoming Protocol drop-down list,  
either TCP or UDP, or All.  
- 227 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
5. Select Enable in Status field.  
6. Click the Save button to save the new rule.  
Figure 8-41 Add or Modify a Port Triggering Entry  
To modify or delete an existing entry:  
1. Click the Modify in the entry you want to modify. If you want to delete the entry, click the  
Delete.  
2. Modify the information.  
3. Click the Save button.  
Click the Enable All button to make all entries enabled.  
Click the Disable All button to make all entries disabled.  
Click the Delete All button to delete all entries.  
Note:  
)
1. When the trigger connection is released, the corresponding opening ports will be closed.  
2. Each rule is allowed to be used only by one host on LAN synchronously. The trigger  
connection of other hosts on LAN will be refused.  
3. Incoming Port Range cannot overlap each other.  
8.9.3 DMZ  
Choose menu “Forwarding DMZ”, and then you can view and configure DMZ host in the  
screen as shown in Figure 8-42. The DMZ host feature allows one local host to be exposed to the  
Internet for a special-purpose service such as Internet gaming or videoconferencing. DMZ host  
forwards all the ports at the same time. Any PC whose port is being forwarded must have its  
DHCP client function disabled and should have a new static IP Address assigned to it because its  
IP Address may be changed when using the DHCP function.  
- 228 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure 8-42 DMZ  
To assign a computer or server to be a DMZ server:  
1. Check the Enable radio button.  
2. Enter the IP Address of a local host in the DMZ Host IP Address field.  
3. Click the Save button.  
Note:  
)
After you set the DMZ host, the firewall related to the host will not work.  
8.9.4 UPnP  
Choose menu “Forwarding UPnP”, and then you can view the information about UPnP  
(Universal Plug and Play) in the screen as shown in Figure 8-43. The UPnP feature allows the  
devices, such as Internet computers, to access the local host resources or devices as needed.  
UPnP devices can be automatically discovered by the UPnP service application on the LAN.  
Figure 8-43 UPnP  
¾
¾
Current UPnP Status - UPnP can be enabled or disabled by clicking the Enable or Disable  
button.  
Current UPnP Settings List - This table displays the current UPnP information.  
App Description - The description provided by the application in the UPnP request.  
External Port - The external port the Router opens for the application.  
Protocol - The type of protocol the Router opens for the application.  
Internal Port - The Internal port the Router opens for local host.  
IP Address - The IP address of the UPnP device that is currently accessing the Router.  
- 229 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Status - The status of the port is displayed here. “Enabled” means that the port is still  
active. Otherwise, the port is inactive.  
Click Refresh to update the Current UPnP Settings List.  
8.10Security  
Figure 8-44 The Security menu  
There are four submenus under the Security menu as shown in Figure 8-44: Basic Security,  
Advanced Security, Local Management and Remote Management. Click any of them, and you  
will be able to configure the corresponding function.  
8.10.1 Basic Security  
Choose menu “Security Basic Security”, you can configure the basic security in the screen  
as shown in Figure 8-45.  
Figure 8-45 Basic Security  
¾
Firewall - A firewall protects your network from the outside world. Here you can enable or  
disable the Router’s firewall.  
z
SPI Firewall - SPI (Stateful Packet Inspection, also known as dynamic packet filtering)  
helps to prevent cyber attacks by tracking more state per session. It validates that the  
- 230 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
traffic passing through the session conforms to the protocol. SPI Firewall is enabled by  
factory default. If you want all the computers on the LAN exposed to the outside world,  
you can disable it.  
¾
VPN - VPN Passthrough must be enabled if you want to allow VPN tunnels using IPSec,  
PPTP, or L2TP protocols to pass through the Router’s firewall.  
z
z
z
PPTP Passthrough - Point-to-Point Tunneling Protocol (PPTP) allows the Point-to-Point  
Protocol (PPP) to be tunneled through an IP network. To allow PPTP tunnels to pass  
through the Router, keep the default, Enabled.  
L2TP Passthrough - Layer 2 Tunneling Protocol (L2TP) is the method used to enable  
Point-to-Point sessions via the Internet on the Layer 2 level. To allow L2TP tunnels to  
pass through the Router, keep the default, Enabled.  
IPSec Passthrough - Internet Protocol Security (IPSec) is a suite of protocols for  
ensuring private, secure communications over Internet Protocol (IP) networks, through  
the use of cryptographic security services. To allow IPSec tunnels to pass through the  
Router, keep the default, Enabled.  
¾
ALG - It is recommended to enable Application Layer Gateway (ALG) because ALG allows  
customized Network Address Translation (NAT) traversal filters to be plugged into the  
gateway to support address and port translation for certain application layer "control/data"  
protocols such as FTP, TFTP, H323 etc.  
z
z
z
FTP ALG - To allow FTP clients and servers to transfer data across NAT, keep the  
default Enable.  
TFTP ALG - To allow TFTP clients and servers to transfer data across NAT, keep the  
default Enable.  
H323 ALG - To allow Microsoft NetMeeting clients to communicate across NAT, keep  
the default Enable.  
Click the Save button to save your settings.  
8.10.2 Advanced Security  
Choose menu “Security Advanced Security”, you can protect the Router from being  
attacked by TCP-SYN Flood, UDP Flood and ICMP-Flood in the screen as shown in Figure 8-46.  
- 231 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure 8-46 Advanced Security  
¾
¾
Packets Statistics Interval (5~60) - The default value is 10. Select a value between 5 and  
60 seconds from the drop-down list. The Packets Statistics Interval value indicates the time  
section of the packets statistics. The result of the statistics is used for analysis by SYN Flood,  
UDP Flood and ICMP-Flood.  
DoS Protection - Denial of Service protection. Check the Enable or Disable button to  
enable or disable the DoS protection function. Only when it is enabled, will the flood filters be  
enabled.  
Note:  
)
Dos Protection will take effect only when the Traffic Statistics in “System Tool Traffic  
Statistics” is enabled.  
¾
¾
Enable ICMP-FLOOD Attack Filtering - Enable or Disable the ICMP-FLOOD Attack  
Filtering.  
ICMP-FLOOD Packets Threshold (5~3600) - The default value is 50. Enter a value  
between 5 ~ 3600. When the current ICMP-FLOOD Packets number is beyond the set value,  
the Router will startup the blocking function immediately.  
¾
¾
Enable UDP-FLOOD Filtering - Enable or Disable the UDP-FLOOD Filtering.  
UDP-FLOOD Packets Threshold (5~3600) - The default value is 500. Enter a value  
between 5 ~ 3600. When the current UPD-FLOOD Packets number is beyond the set value,  
the Router will startup the blocking function immediately.  
- 232 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
¾
¾
Enable TCP-SYN-FLOOD Attack Filtering - Enable or Disable the TCP-SYN-FLOOD  
Attack Filtering.  
TCP-SYN-FLOOD Packets Threshold (5~3600) - The default value is 50. Enter a value  
between 5 ~ 3600. When the current TCP-SYN-FLOOD Packets numbers is beyond the set  
value, the Router will startup the blocking function immediately.  
¾
¾
Ignore Ping Packet From WAN Port - Enable or Disable Ignore Ping Packet From WAN  
Port. The default setting is disabled. If enabled, the ping packet from the Internet cannot  
access the Router.  
Forbid Ping Packet From LAN Port - Enable or Disable Forbid Ping Packet From LAN Port.  
The default setting is disabled. If enabled, the ping packet from LAN cannot access the  
Router. This function can be used to defend against some viruses.  
Click the Save button to save the settings.  
Click the Blocked DoS Host List button to display the DoS host table by blocking.  
8.10.3 Local Management  
Choose menu “Security Local Management”, you can configure the management rule in the  
screen as shown in Figure 8-47. The management feature allows you to deny computers in LAN  
from accessing the Router.  
Figure 8-47 Local Management  
By default, the radio button “All the PCs on the LAN are allowed to access the Router's  
Web-Based Utility” is checked. If you want to allow PCs with specific MAC Addresses to access  
the Setup page of the Router's Web-Based Utility locally from inside the network, check the radio  
button “Only the PCs listed can browse the built-in web pages to perform Administrator  
tasks”, and then enter each MAC Address in a separate field. The format for the MAC Address is  
XX-XX-XX-XX-XX-XX (X is any hexadecimal digit). Only the PCs with MAC address listed can  
- 233 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
use the password to browse the built-in web pages to perform Administrator tasks while all the  
others will be blocked.  
After click the Add button, your PC's MAC Address will be placed in the list above.  
Click the Save button to save your settings.  
Note:  
)
If your PC is blocked but you want to access the Router again, press and hold the WPS button  
for more than 5 seconds to reset the Router to factory defaults.  
8.10.4 Remote Management  
You can configure the Remote Management function on this page. This feature allows you to  
manage your Router from a remote location, via the Internet.  
Figure 8-48 Remote Management  
¾
Web Management Port - Web browser access normally uses the standard HTTP service  
port 80. This router’s default remote management Web port number is 80. For greater  
security, you can change the remote management Web interface to a custom port by  
entering that number in this box provided. Choose a number between 1024 and 65535, but  
do not use the number of any common service port.  
¾
Remote Management IP Address - This is the current address you will use when  
accessing your router from the Internet. The default IP Address is 0.0.0.0. It means this  
function is disabled. To enable this function, change the default IP Address to another IP  
Address as desired.  
To access the router, you will type your router's WAN IP Address into your browser's Address (in  
IE) or Location (in Navigator) box, followed by a colon and the custom port number. For example,  
if your Router's WAN address is 202.96.12.8 and you use port number 8080, enter in your  
browser: http://202.96.12.8:8080. You will be asked for the router's password. After successfully  
entering the password, you will be able to access the router's Web-based utility.  
Note:  
)
Be sure to change the router's default password to a very secure password.  
- 234 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
8.11 Parental Control  
Choose menu “Parental Control”, and you can configure the parental control in the screen as  
shown in Figure 8-49. The Parental Control function can be used to control the internet activities  
of the child, limit the child to access certain websites and restrict the time of surfing.  
Figure 8-49 Parental Control Settings  
¾
¾
Parental Control - Check Enable if you want this function to take effect, otherwise check  
Disable.  
MAC Address of Parental PC - In this field, enter the MAC address of the controlling PC, or  
you can make use of the Copy To Above button below.  
¾
MAC Address of Your PC - This field displays the MAC address of the PC that is managing  
this Router. If the MAC Address of your adapter is registered, you can click the Copy To  
Above button to fill this address to the MAC Address of Parental PC field above.  
¾
¾
Website Description - Description of the allowed website for the PC controlled.  
Schedule - The time period allowed for the PC controlled to access the Internet. For detailed  
information, please go to “Access RestrictionSchedule”.  
¾
Modify - Here you can edit or delete an existing entry.  
To add a new entry, please follow the steps below.  
1. Click the Add New… button and the next screen will pop-up as shown in Figure 8-49.  
2. Enter the MAC address of the PC (e.g. 00-11-22-33-44-AA) you’d like to control in the MAC  
Address of Child PC field. Or you can choose the MAC address from the All Address in  
Current LAN drop-down list.  
3. Give a description (e.g. Allow Google) for the website allowed to be accessed in the Website  
Description field.  
- 235 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
4. Enter the allowed domain name of the website, either the full name or the keywords (e.g.  
google) in the Allowed Domain Name field. Any domain name with keywords in it  
(e.g.www.google.com) will be allowed.  
5. Select from the Effective Time drop-down list the schedule (e.g. Schedule_1) you want the  
entry to take effect. If there are not suitable schedules for you, click the Schedule in red below  
to go to the Advance Schedule Settings page and create the schedule you need.  
6. In the Status field, you can select Enabled or Disabled to enable or disable your entry.  
7. Click the Save button.  
Click the Enable All button to enable all the rules in the list.  
Click the Disable All button to disable all the rules in the list.  
Click the Delete All button to delete all the entries in the table.  
Click the Next button to go to the next page, or click the Previous button return to the previous  
page.  
Figure 8-50 Add or Modify Parental Control Entry  
For example: If you desire that the child PC with MAC address 00-11-22-33-44-AA can access  
www.google.com on Saturday only while the parent PC with MAC address 00-11-22-33-44-BB is  
without any restriction, you should follow the settings below.  
1. Click Parental Control” menu on the left to enter the Parental Control Settings page. Check  
Enable and enter the MAC address 00-11-22-33-44-BB in the MAC Address of Parental PC  
field.  
- 236 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
2. Click Access Restriction Schedule” on the left to enter the Schedule Settings page.  
Click Add New... button to create a new schedule with Schedule Description is Schedule_1,  
Day is Sat and Time is all day-24 hours.  
3. Click Parental Control” menu on the left to go back to the Add or Modify Parental Control  
Entry page:  
z Click Add New... button.  
z Enter 00-11-22-33-44-AA in the MAC Address of Child PC field.  
z Enter “Allow Google” in the Website Description field.  
z Enter “www.google.com” in the Allowed Domain Name field.  
z Select “Schedule_1” you create just now from the Effective Time drop-down list.  
z In Status field, select Enable.  
4. Click Save to complete the settings.  
Then you will go back to the Parental Control Settings page and see the following list, as shown in  
Figure 8-51  
8.12 Access Control  
Figure 8-52 The Access Control menu  
There are four submenus under the Access Restriction menu as shown in Figure 8-52: Rule,  
Host, Target and Schedule. Click any of them, and you will be able to configure the  
corresponding function.  
8.12.1 Rule  
Choose menu “Access ControlRule”, you can view and set Access Restriction rules in the  
screen as shown in Figure 8-53.  
- 237 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure 8-53 Access Control Rule Management  
¾
Enable Internet Access Restriction - Select the check box to enable the Internet Access  
Restriction function, so the Default Filter Policy can take effect.  
¾
¾
¾
¾
¾
Rule Name - Here displays the name of the rule and this name is unique.  
Host - Here displays the host selected in the corresponding rule.  
Target - Here displays the target selected in the corresponding rule.  
Schedule - Here displays the schedule selected in the corresponding rule.  
Action - Here displays the action the Router takes to deal with the packets. It could be Allow  
or Deny. Allow means that the Router permits the packets to go through the Router. Deny  
means that the Router rejects the packets to go through the Router.  
¾
¾
Status - This field displays the status of the rule. Enabled means the rule will take effect,  
Disabled means the rule will not take effect.  
Modify - Here you can edit or delete an existing rule.  
To add a new rule, please follow the steps below.  
1. Click the Add New… button and the next screen will pop-up as shown in Figure 8-53.  
2. Give a name (e.g. Rule_1) for the rule in the Rule Name field.  
3. Select a host from the Host drop-down list or choose “Click Here To Add New Host List”.  
4. Select a target from the Target drop-sown list or choose “Click Here To Add New Target  
List”.  
5. Select a schedule from the Schedule drop-down list or choose “Click Here To Add New  
Schedule”.  
- 238 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
6. In the Action field, select Deny or Allow.  
7. In the Status field, select Enabled or Disabled to enable or disable your entry.  
8. Click the Save button.  
Click the Enable All button to enable all the rules in the list.  
Click the Disable All button to disable all the rules in the list.  
Click the Delete All button to delete all the entries in the table.  
You can change the entry’s order as desired. Fore entries are before hind entries. Enter the ID  
number in the first box you want to move and another ID number in second box you want to move  
to, and then click the Move button to change the entry’s order.  
Click the Next button to go to the next page, or click the Previous button return to the previous  
page.  
Figure 8-54 Add or Modify Internet Access Restriction Entry  
For example: If you desire to allow the host with MAC address 00-11-22-33-44-AA to access  
www.google.com only from 18:00 to 20:00 on Saturday and Sunday, and forbid other hosts in  
the LAN to access the Internet, you should follow the settings below:  
1. Click Access Restriction Host” in the left to enter the Host Settings page. Add a new  
entry with the Host Description is Host_1 and MAC Address is 00-11-22-33-44-AA.  
2. Click Access Restriction Target” in the left to enter the Target Settings page. Add a  
new entry with the Target Description is Target_1 and Domain Name is www.google.com.  
3. Click Access Restriction Schedule” in the left to enter the Schedule Settings page.  
Add a new entry with the Schedule Description is Schedule_1, Day is Sat and Sun, Start  
Time is 1800 and Stop Time is 2000.  
4. Click Access Restriction Rule” in the left to return to the Access Restriction Rule  
Management page. Select “Enable Internet Access Restriction” and choose "Deny the  
packets not specified by any access Restriction policy to pass through the Router".  
5. Click Add New... button to add a new rule as follows:  
- 239 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
z
In Rule Name field, create a name for the rule. Note that this name should be unique, for  
example Rule_1.  
z
z
z
z
z
z
In Host field, select Host_1.  
In Target field, select Target_1.  
In Schedule field, select Schedule_1.  
In Action field, select Allow.  
In Status field, select Enabled.  
Click Save to complete the settings.  
Then you will go back to the Access Restriction Rule Management page and see the following list.  
Figure 8-55 Rule Settings  
8.12.2 Host  
Choose menu “Access Control Host”, you can view and set a Host list in the screen as  
shown in Figure 8-56. The host list is necessary for the Access Restriction Rule.  
Figure 8-56 Host Settings  
¾
¾
¾
Host Description - Here displays the description of the host and this description is unique.  
Information - Here displays the information about the host. It can be IP or MAC.  
Modify - To modify or delete an existing entry.  
To add a new entry, please follow the steps below.  
1. Click the Add New… button.  
2. In the Mode field, select IP Address or MAC Address.  
z
If you select IP Address, the screen shown is Figure 8-57.  
1) In Host Description field, create a unique description for the host (e.g. Host_1).  
- 240 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
2) In LAN IP Address field, enter the IP address.  
z
If you select MAC Address, the screen shown is Figure 8-58.  
1) In Host Description field, create a unique description for the host (e.g. Host_1).  
2) In MAC Address field, enter the MAC address.  
3. Click the Save button to complete the settings.  
Click the Delete All button to delete all the entries in the table.  
Click the Next button to go to the next page, or click the Previous button return to the previous  
page.  
Figure 8-57 Add or Modify a Host Entry  
Figure 8-58 Add or Modify a Host Entry  
For example: If you desire to restrict the internet activities of host with MAC address  
00-11-22-33-44-AA, you should first follow the settings below:  
1. Click Add New... button in Figure 8-56 to enter the Add or Modify a Host Entry page.  
2. In Mode field, select MAC Address from the drop-down list.  
3. In Host Description field, create a unique description for the host (e.g. Host_1).  
4. In MAC Address field, enter 00-11-22-33-44-AA.  
5. Click Save to complete the settings.  
Then you will go back to the Host Settings page and see the following list.  
- 241 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure 8-59 Host Settings  
8.12.3 Target  
Choose menu “Access Control Target”, you can view and set a Target list in the screen as  
shown in Figure 4-64. The target list is necessary for the Access Restriction Rule.  
Figure 8-60 Target Settings  
¾
Target Description - Here displays the description about the target and this description is  
unique.  
¾
¾
Information - The target can be IP address, port, or domain name.  
Modify - To modify or delete an existing entry.  
To add a new entry, please follow the steps below.  
1. Click the Add New… button.  
2. In Mode field, select IP Address or Domain Name.  
z
If you select IP Address, the screen shown is Figure 8-61.  
1) In Target Description field, create a unique description for the target (e.g.  
Target_1).  
2) In IP Address field, enter the IP address of the target.  
3) Select a common service from Common Service Port drop-down list, so that the  
Target Port will be automatically filled. If the Common Service Port drop-down list  
doesn’t have the service you want, specify the Target Port manually.  
4) In Protocol field, select TCP, UDP, ICMP or ALL.  
z
If you select Domain Name, the screen shown is Figure 8-62.  
1) In Target Description field, create a unique description for the target (e.g.  
Target_1).  
- 242 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
2) In Domain Name field, enter the domain name, either the full name or the keywords  
(for example Google) in the blank. Any domain name with keywords in it  
(e.g.www.google.com) will be blocked or allowed. You can enter 4 domain names.  
3. Click the Save button.  
Click the Delete All button to delete all the entries in the table.  
Click the Next button to go to the next page, or click the Previous button return to the previous  
page.  
Figure 8-61 Add or Modify an Access Target Entry  
Figure 8-62 Add or Modify an Access Target Entry  
For example: If you desire to restrict the internet activities of host with MAC address  
00-11-22-33-44-AA in the LAN to access www.google.com only, you should first follow the  
settings below:  
1. Click Add New… button in Figure 8-60 to enter the Add or Modify an Access Target Entry  
page.  
2. In Mode field, select Domain Name from the drop-down list.  
3. In Target Description field, create a unique description for the target (e.g. Target_1).  
4. In Domain Name field, enter www.google.com.  
5. Click Save to complete the settings.  
- 243 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Then you will go back to the Target Settings page and see the following list,  
Figure 8-63 Target Settings  
8.12.4 Schedule  
Choose menu “Access Control Schedule”, you can view and set a Schedule list in the next  
screen as shown in Figure 8-64. The Schedule list is necessary for the Access Restriction Rule.  
Figure 8-64 Schedule Settings  
¾
Schedule Description - Here displays the description of the schedule and this description is  
unique.  
¾
¾
¾
Day - Here displays the day(s) in a week.  
Time - Here displays the time period in a day.  
Modify - Here you can edit or delete an existing schedule.  
To add a new schedule, follow the steps below.  
1. Click Add New... button shown in Figure 8-64 and the next screen will pop-up as shown in  
2. In Schedule Description field, create a unique description for the schedule (e.g.  
Schedule_1).  
3. In Day field, select the day or days you need.  
4. In Time field, you can select all day-24 hours or you may enter the Start Time and Stop Time  
in the corresponding field.  
5. Click Save to complete the settings.  
Click the Delete All button to delete all the entries in the table.  
- 244 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Click the Next button to go to the next page, or click the Previous button return to the previous  
page.  
Figure 8-65 Advanced Schedule Settings  
For example: If you desire to restrict the internet activities of host with MAC address  
00-11-22-33-44-AA to access www.google.com only from 18:00 to 20:00 on Saturday and  
Sunday, you should first follow the settings below:  
1. Click Add New... button shown in Figure 8-64 to enter the Advanced Schedule Settings  
page.  
2. In Schedule Description field, create a unique description for the schedule (e.g.  
Schedule_1).  
3. In Day field, check the Select Days radio button and then select Sat and Sun.  
4. In Time field, enter 1800 in Start Time field and 2000 in Stop Time field.  
5. Click Save to complete the settings.  
Then you will go back to the Schedule Settings page and see the following list.  
Figure 8-66 Schedule Settings  
- 245 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
8.13 Advanced Routing  
Figure 8-67 The Advanced Routing Menu  
There are two submenus under the Network menu (shown in Figure 4-71): Static Routing List  
and System Routing Table. Click any of them, and you will be able to configure the  
corresponding function.  
8.13.1 Static Routing List  
Choose menu “Static Routing”, and you can configure the static route in the next screen, shown  
in Figure 8-68. A static route is a pre-determined path that network information must travel to  
reach a specific host or network.  
Figure 8-68 Static Routing  
To add static routing entries, follow the steps below.  
Figure 8-69 Add or Modify a Static Route Entry  
2. Enter the following data.  
¾ Destination Network - The Destination IP Address is the address of the network or host  
that you want to assign to a static route.  
- 246 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
¾
Subnet Mask - The Subnet Mask determines which portion of an IP Address is the  
network portion, and which portion is the host portion.  
¾ Default Gateway - This is the IP Address of the gateway device that allows for contact  
between the Router and the network or host.  
3. Select Enabled or Disabled for this entry on the Status drop-down list.  
4. Click the Save button to make the entry take effect.  
Click the Delete button to delete the entry.  
Click the Enable All button to enable all the entries.  
Click the Disable All button to disable all the entries.  
Click the Delete All button to delete all the entries.  
Click the Previous button to view the information in the previous screen, click the Next  
button to view the information in the next screen.  
8.13.2 System Routing Table  
Choose menu “Advanced Routing System Routing Table”, and you can views all of the  
valid route entries in use. The Destination IP address, Subnet Mask, Gateway, and Interface will  
be displayed for each entry.  
Figure 8-70 Routing Table  
¾
¾
¾
¾
Destination Network - The Destination IP Address is the address of the network or host to  
which the static route is assigned.  
Subnet Mask - The Subnet Mask determines which portion of an IP address is the network  
portion, and which portion is the host portion.  
Gateway - This is the IP address of the gateway device that allows for contact between the  
Router and the network or host.  
Interface - This interface tells you whether the Destination IP Address is on the LAN &  
WLAN (internal wired and wireless networks), the WAN (Internet).  
Click the Refresh button to refresh the data displayed.  
- 247 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
8.14Bandwidth Control  
Figure 8-71 The Bandwidth Control menu  
There are two submenus under the Bandwidth Control menu as shown in Figure 8-71. Click any  
of them, and you will be able to configure the corresponding function. The detailed explanations  
for each submenu are provided below.  
8.14.1 Control Settings  
Choose menu “Bandwidth Control Control Settings”, you can configure the Egress  
Bandwidth and Ingress Bandwidth in the next screen. Their values you configure should be less  
than 100000Kbps. For optimal control of the bandwidth, please select the right Line Type and ask  
your ISP for the total bandwidth of the egress and ingress.  
Figure 8-72 Bandwidth Control Settings  
¾
¾
Enable Bandwidth Control - Check this box so that the Bandwidth Control settings can take  
effect.  
Line Type - Select the right type for you network connection. If you don’t know how to choose,  
please ask your ISP for the information.  
¾
¾
Egress Bandwidth - The upload speed through the WAN port.  
Ingress Bandwidth - The download speed through the WAN port.  
8.14.2 Rule List  
Choose menu “Bandwidth Control Rule List”, you can view and configure the Bandwidth  
Control rules in the screen below.  
- 248 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure 8-73 Bandwidth Control Rule List  
¾
Description - This is the information about the rules such as address range.  
¾
Egress Bandwidth - This field displays the max and mix upload bandwidth through the WAN  
port, the default is 0.  
¾
Ingress Bandwidth - This field displays the max and mix download bandwidth through the  
WAN port, the default is 0.  
¾
¾
Enable - This displays the status of the rule.  
Modify - Click Modify to edit the rule. Click Delete to delete the rule.  
To add/modify a Bandwidth Control rule, follow the steps below.  
Step 2: Enter the information like the screen shown below.  
Figure 8-74 Bandwidth Control Rule Settings  
¾ Enable - Enable or disable the rule.  
¾ IP Range - Interior PC address range. If both are blank (or 0.0.0.0), the domain is no  
effective.  
¾ Port Range - The port range which the Interior PC access the outside PC. If all are blank  
(or 0), the domain is no effective.  
¾ Protocol - Transport layer protocol, here there are All, TCP, UDP.  
- 249 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
¾ Egress Bandwidth - The max and the min upload speed which through the WAN port,  
default number is 0.  
¾ Ingress Bandwidth - The max and the min download speed through the WAN port,  
default number is 0.  
Step 3: Click the Save button.  
8.15 IP & MAC Binding  
Figure 8-75 The IP & MAC Binding menu  
There are two submenus under the IP & MAC Binding menu: Binding Setting and ARP List.  
Click any of them, and you will be able to scan or configure the corresponding function. The  
detailed explanations for each submenu are provided below.  
8.15.1 Binding Setting  
This page displays the IP & MAC Binding Setting table; you can operate it in accord with your  
desire.  
Figure 8-76 IP & MAC Binding Setting  
¾
¾
¾
¾
MAC Address - The MAC address of the controlled computer in the LAN.  
IP Address - The assigned IP address of the controlled computer in the LAN.  
Bind - Whether or not enable the ARP binding.  
Modify - Edit or delete item.  
- 250 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
When you want to add or modify an IP & MAC Binding entry, you can click the Add New button  
or Modify button, and then you will go to the next page. This page is used for adding or  
modifying an IP & MAC Binding entry.  
Figure 8-77 IP & MAC Binding Setting (Add & Modify)  
To add IP & MAC Binding entries:  
1. Click the Add New.. button.  
2. Enter the MAC Address and IP Address.  
3. Select the Bind checkbox.  
4. Click the Save button to save it.  
To modify or delete an existing entry:  
1. Find the desired entry in the table.  
2. Click Modify or Delete as desired on the Modify column.  
To find an existing entry:  
1. Click the Find button (shown in Figure 8-76).  
2. Enter the MAC Address or IP Address.  
3. Enter the Find button in the next page (shown in Figure 8-78).  
Figure 8-78 Find IP & MAC Binding Entry  
- 251 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Click the Enable All button to make all entries enabled.  
Click the Delete All button to delete all entries.  
8.15.2 ARP List  
To manage the computer, you could observe the computers in the LAN by checking the  
relationship of MAC address and IP address on the ARP list, and you could configure the items on  
the ARP list also. This page displays the ARP List; it shows all the existing IP & MAC Binding  
entries.  
Figure 8-79 ARP List  
¾
¾
¾
¾
¾
¾
MAC Address - The MAC address of the controlled computer in the LAN.  
IP Address - The assigned IP address of the controlled computer in the LAN.  
Status - Enabled or Disabled of the MAC address and IP address binding.  
Configure - Load or delete item.  
Load - Load the item to the IP & MAC Binding list.  
Delete - Delete the item.  
1. Click the Bind All button to bind all the current items, available after enable.  
2. Click the Load All button to load all items to the IP & MAC Binding list.  
3. Click the Refresh button to refresh all items.  
Note:  
)
An item could not be loaded to the IP & MAC Binding list if the IP address of the item has been  
loaded before. Error warning will prompt as well. Likewise, "Load All" only loads the items without  
interference to the IP & MAC Binding list.  
8.16 Dynamic DNS  
The Router offers the DDNS (Dynamic Domain Name System) feature, which allows the hosting  
of a website, FTP server, or e-mail server with a fixed domain name (named by yourself) and a  
dynamic IP address, and then your friends can connect to your server by entering your domain  
- 252 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
name no matter what your IP address is. Before using this feature, you need to sign up for DDNS  
service providers such as www.no-ip.com, www.comexe.cn, or www.dyndns.org. The Dynamic  
DNS client service provider will give you a password or key.  
8.16.1 No-IP DDNS  
If the dynamic DNS Service Provider you select is www.no-ip.com, the page will appear as  
shown in Figure 8-80.  
Figure 8-80 No-IP DDNS Settings  
To set up for DDNS, follow these instructions:  
1. Type the User Name for your DDNS account.  
2. Type the Password for your DDNS account.  
3. Type the Domain Name you received from dynamic DNS service provider.  
4. Click the Login button to log in the DDNS service.  
Connection Status - The status of the DDNS service connection is displayed here.  
Click Logout to log out the DDNS service.  
Note:  
)
If you want to login again with another account after a successful login, please click the Logout  
button, then input your new username and password and click the Login button.  
- 253 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
8.16.2 Comexe.cn DDNS  
If the dynamic DNS Service Provider you select is www.comexe.cn, the page will appear as  
shown in Figure 8-81.  
Figure 8-81 Comexe.cn DDNS Settings  
To set up for DDNS, follow these instructions:  
1. Type the Domain Name received from your dynamic DNS service provider.  
2. Type the User Name for your DDNS account.  
3. Type the Password for your DDNS account.  
4. Click the Login button to log in to the DDNS service.  
Connection Status -The status of the DDNS service connection is displayed here.  
Click Logout to log out of the DDNS service.  
- 254 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
8.16.3 Dyndns org DDNS  
If the dynamic DNS Service Provider you select is www.dyndns.org, the page will appear as  
shown in Figure 8-82.  
Figure 8-82 Dyndns.org DDNS Settings  
To set up for DDNS, follow these instructions:  
1. Type the User Name for your DDNS account.  
2. Type the Password for your DDNS account.  
3. Type the Domain Name you received from dynamic DNS service provider here.  
4. Click the Login button to log in to the DDNS service.  
Connection Status -The status of the DDNS service connection is displayed here.  
Click Logout to logout of the DDNS service.  
- 255 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
8.17 System Tools  
Figure 8-83 The System Tools menu  
There are nine submenus under the System Tools menu: Time Settings, Diagnostic, Firmware  
Upgrade, Factory Defaults, Backup and Restore, Reboot, Password, System Log and  
Statistics. Click any of them, and you will be able to configure the corresponding function. The  
detailed explanations for each submenu are provided below.  
8.17.1 Time Settings  
You can set time manually or get GMT from the Internet for the router on this page:  
Figure 8-84 Time Settings  
- 256 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Time Zone - Select your local time zone from this pull-down list.  
¾
¾
¾
Date - Enter your local date in MM/DD/YY into the right blanks.  
Time - Enter your local time in HH/MM/SS into the right blanks.  
To set time manually, follow the steps below:  
1. Select your local time zone.  
2. Enter the Date in Month/Day/Year format.  
3. Enter the Time in Hour/Minute/Second format.  
4. Click Save.  
For automatic time synchronization:  
1. Enter the address of the NTP Server 1 or NTP Server 2.  
2. Click the Get GMT button to get GMT time from Internet if you have connected to Internet.  
Note:  
)
This setting will be used for some time-based functions such as firewall. You must specify your  
time zone once you login to the router successfully, if not, the time limited on these functions will  
not take effect.  
¾
¾
The time will be lost if the router is turned off.  
The router will obtain GMT automatically from Internet if it has already connected to Internet.  
8.17.2 Diagnostic  
Choose menu “System Tools Diagnostic”, you can transact Ping or Traceroute function to  
check connectivity of your network in the following screen.  
Figure 8-85 Diagnostic Tools  
- 257 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Diagnostic Tool - Check the radio button to select one diagnostic too.  
¾
Ping - This diagnostic tool troubleshoots connectivity, reachability, and name resolution to  
a given host or gateway.  
Traceroute - This diagnostic tool tests the performance of a connection.  
)
Note:  
You can use ping/traceroute to test both numeric IP address or domain name. If  
pinging/tracerouting the IP address is successful, but pinging/tracerouting the domain name is not,  
you might have a name resolution problem. In this case, ensure that the domain name you are  
specifying can be resolved by using Domain Name System (DNS) queries.  
¾
IP Address/Domain Name - Type the destination IP address (such as 202.108.22.5) or  
Domain name (such as www.baidu.com).  
¾
¾
¾
Pings Count - The number of Ping packets for a Ping connection.  
Ping Packet Size - The size of Ping packet.  
Ping Timeout - Set the waiting time for the reply of each Ping packet. If there is no reply in  
the specified time, the connection is overtime.  
¾
Traceroute Max TTL - The max number of hops for a Traceroute connection.  
Click Start to check the connectivity of the Internet.  
The Diagnostic Results page displays the result of diagnosis.  
If the result is similar to the following screen, the connectivity of the Internet is fine.  
Figure 8-86 Diagnostic Results  
Note:  
)
Only one user can use this tool at one time. "Ping Count", "Ping Packet Size" and "Ping Timeout"  
are Ping Parameters. "Traceroute Max TTL" is Traceroute Parameter.  
- 258 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
8.17.3 Firmware Upgrade  
The page allows you to upgrade the latest version firmware to keep your router up-to-date.  
Figure 8-87 Firmware Upgrade  
New firmware is posted at www.tp-link.com and can be downloaded for free. If the router is not  
experiencing difficulties, there is no need to upgrade firmware, unless the new firmware supports  
a new feature you need.  
Note:  
)
1. When you upgrade the router's firmware, you will lose current configuration settings, so make  
sure you backup the router’s settings before you upgrade its firmware.  
2. Make sure that your computer is connected to the Internet through the cable when you  
upgrade the firmware. To upgrade through wireless connection is not allowed.  
3. Set your IP address as static IP before upgrading.  
To upgrade the router's firmware, follow these instructions:  
1. Download the latest firmware upgrade file from our website http://www.tp-link.com.  
2. Enter or select the path name where you save the downloaded file on the computer into the  
File blank.  
3. Click the Upgrade button.  
¾
¾
Firmware Version - Displays the current firmware version.  
Hardware Version - Displays the current hardware version. The hardware version of the  
upgrade file must accord with the current hardware version.  
Note:  
)
The firmware version must correspond to the hardware. The upgrade process takes a few minutes  
and the Router will restart automatically when the upgrade is completed. It is important to keep  
power on during the entire process. Loss of power during the upgrade could damage the Router.  
- 259 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
8.17.4 Factory Defaults  
This page allows you to restore the factory default settings for the router.  
Figure 8-88 Restore Factory Default  
Click the Restore button to reset all configuration settings to their default values.  
¾
¾
¾
The default User Name: admin  
The default Password: admin  
The default access: tplinklogin.net  
Note:  
)
Any settings you have saved will be lost when the default settings are restored.  
8.17.5 Backup & Restore  
This page allows you to save current configuration of router as backup or restore the configuration  
file you saved before.  
Figure 8-89 Backup & Restore Configuration  
¾
¾
Click the Backup button to save all configuration settings as a backup file in your local  
computer.  
To restore the router's configuration, follow these instructions:  
Click the Browse button to select the backup file which you want to restore.  
Click the Restore button.  
Note:  
)
The current configuration will be covered with the uploading configuration file. The restoration  
process lasts for 20 seconds and the router will restart automatically. Keep the router on during the  
restoring process to prevent any damage.  
- 260 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
8.17.6 Reboot  
This page allows you to reboot the router.  
Figure 8-90 Reboot the router  
Click the Reboot button to reboot the router.  
Some settings of the router will take effect only after rebooting, which include:  
¾
¾
¾
¾
¾
¾
¾
Change LAN IP Address. (System will reboot automatically)  
MAC Clone (system will reboot automatically)  
DHCP service function.  
Static address assignment of DHCP server.  
Web Service Port of the router.  
Upgrade the firmware of the router (system will reboot automatically).  
Restore the router's settings to factory default (system will reboot automatically).  
8.17.7 Password  
This page allows you to change the factory default user name and password of the router.  
Figure 8-91 Password  
It is recommended strongly that you change the factory default user name and password of the  
router. All users who try to access the router's Web-based utility or Quick Setup will be prompted  
Note:  
)
The new user name and password must not exceed 14 characters in length and must not include  
any spaces. Enter the new Password twice to confirm it.  
- 261 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
button when finished.  
Click the  
Save  
Click the Clear All button to clear all.  
8.17.8 System Log  
This page allows you to query the logs of the router.  
Figure 8-92 System Log  
Refresh - Refresh the page to show the latest log list.  
¾
¾
¾
Save Log - Click to save all the logs in a txt file.  
Mail Log - Click to send an email of current logs manually according to the address and  
validation information set in Mail Settings. The result will be shown in the later log soon.  
¾
Clear Log - All the logs will be deleted from this device permanently, not just from the page.  
8.17.9 Statistics  
The Statistics page displays the network traffic of each PC in LAN, including total traffic and traffic  
of the last Packets Statistic interval seconds.  
- 262 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure 8-93 Statistics  
¾
Current Statistics Status - Enable or Disable. The default value is disabled. To enable, click  
the Enable button. If disabled, the function of DoS protection in Security settings will be  
ineffective.  
¾
¾
Packets Statistics Interval - The default value is 10. Select a value between 5 and 60  
seconds in the pull-down list. The Packets Statistic interval indicates the time section of the  
packets statistic.  
Sorted Rules - Here displays sort as desired.  
Statistics Table:  
IP Address  
Packets  
The IP Address displayed with statistics  
The total amount of packets received and transmitted by the  
router.  
Total  
Bytes  
The total amount of bytes received and transmitted by the router.  
The total amount of packets received and transmitted in the last  
Packets Statistic interval seconds.  
Packets  
The total amount of bytes received and transmitted in the last  
Packets Statistic interval seconds.  
Bytes  
ICMP Tx  
The total amount of the ICMP packets transmitted to WAN in the  
last Packets Statistic interval seconds.  
Current  
The total amount of the UDP packets transmitted to WAN in the  
last Packets Statistic interval seconds.  
UDP Tx  
The total amount of the TCP SYN packets transmitted to WAN in  
the last Packets Statistic interval seconds.  
TCP SYN Tx  
Click the Save button to save the Packets Statistic interval value.  
Click the Auto-refresh checkbox to refresh automatically.  
Click the Refresh button to refresh immediately.  
- 263 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Appendix A: FAQ  
1. How do I configure the Router to access the Internet by ADSL users?  
1) First, configure the ADSL Modem configured in RFC1483 bridge model.  
2) Connect the Ethernet cable from your ADSL Modem to the WAN port on the Router. The  
telephone cord plugs into the Line port of the ADSL Modem.  
3) Log in to the Router, click the “Network” menu on the left of your browser, and click  
"WAN" submenu. On the WAN page, select “PPPoE/Russia PPPoE” for WAN  
Connection Type. Type user name in the “User Name” field and password in the  
Password” field and the “Confirm Password” field, and finish it by clicking Connect.  
Figure A-1 PPPoE Connection Type  
4) If your ADSL lease is in “pay-according-time” mode, select “Connect on Demand” or  
Connect Manually” for Internet connection mode. Type an appropriate number for  
Max Idle Time” to avoid wasting paid time. Otherwise, you can select “Auto-connecting”  
for Internet connection mode.  
Figure A-2 PPPoE Connection Mode  
Note:  
)
1. Sometimes the connection cannot be disconnected although you specify a time to Max Idle  
Time, since some applications is visiting the Internet continually in the background.  
2. If you are a Cable user, please configure the Router following the above steps.  
- 264 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
2. How do I configure the Router to access the Internet by Ethernet users?  
1) Log in to the Router, click the “Network” menu on the left of your browser, and click  
"WAN" submenu. On the WAN page, select “Dynamic IP” for "WAN Connection Type",  
finish by clicking Save.  
2) Some ISPs require that you register the MAC Address of your adapter, which is  
connected to your cable/DSL Modem during installation. If your ISP requires MAC  
register, log in to the Router and click the "Network" menu link on the left of your browser,  
and then click "MAC Clone" submenu link. On the "MAC Clone" page, if your PC’s MAC  
address is proper MAC address, click the Clone MAC Address button and your PC’s  
MAC address will fill in the "WAN MAC Address" field. Or else, type the MAC Address  
into the "WAN MAC Address" field. The format for the MAC Address is  
XX-XX-XX-XX-XX-XX. Then click the Save button. It will take effect after rebooting.  
Figure A-3 MAC Clone  
3. I want to use NetMeeting, what do I need to do?  
1) If you start NetMeeting as a sponsor, you don’t need to do anything with the Router.  
2) If you start as a response, you need to configure Virtual Server or DMZ Host and make  
sure the H323 ALG is enabled.  
3) How to configure Virtual Server: Log in to the Router, click the “Forwarding” menu on  
the left of your browser, and click "Virtual Servers" submenu. On the "Virtual Servers"  
page, click Add New…. Then on the “Add or Modify a Virtual Server Entry” page,  
enter “1720” for the “Service Port” blank, and your IP address for the “IP Address” blank,  
taking 192.168.0.169 for an example, remember to Enable and Save.  
- 265 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure A-4 Virtual Servers  
Figure A-5 Add or Modify a Virtual server Entry  
Note:  
)
Your opposite side should call your WAN IP, which is displayed on the “Status” page.  
4) How to enable DMZ Host: Log in to the Router, click the “Forwarding” menu on the left  
of your browser, and click "DMZ" submenu. On the "DMZ" page, click Enable radio  
button and type your IP address into the “DMZ Host IP Address” field, using  
192.168.0.169 as an example, remember to click the Save button.  
Figure A-6 DMZ  
4. I want to build a WEB Server on the LAN, what should I do?  
1) Because the WEB Server port 80 will interfere with the WEB management port 80 on the  
Router, you must change the WEB management port number to avoid interference.  
- 266 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
2) To change the WEB management port number: Log in to the Router, click the “Security”  
menu on the left of your browser, and click "Remote Management" submenu. On the  
"Remote Management" page, type a port number except 80, such as 88, into the "Web  
Management Port" field. Click Save and reboot the Router.  
Figure A-7 Remote Management  
Note:  
)
If the above configuration takes effect, configure to the Router by typing 192.168.0.188 (the  
Router’s LAN IP address: Web Management Port) in the address field of the Web browser.  
3) Log in to the Router, click the “Forwarding” menu on the left of your browser, and click  
the "Virtual Servers" submenu. On the "Virtual Servers" page, click Add New…, then  
on the “Add or Modify a Virtual Server” page, enter “88” into the blank next to the  
Service Port”, and your IP address next to the “IP Address”, assuming 192.168.0.188  
for an example, remember to Enable and Save.  
Figure A-8 Virtual Servers  
- 267 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Figure A-9 Add or Modify a Virtual server Entry  
5. The wireless stations cannot connect to the Router.  
1) Make sure the "Enable Wireless Router Radio" is checked.  
2) Make sure that the wireless stations' SSID accord with the Router's SSID.  
3) Make sure the wireless stations have right KEY for encryption when the Router is  
encrypted.  
4) If the wireless connection is ready, but you can’t access the Router, check the IP Address  
of your wireless stations.  
- 268 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Appendix B: Configuring the PC  
In this section, we’ll introduce how to install and configure the TCP/IP correctly in Windows XP.  
First make sure your Ethernet Adapter is working, refer to the adapter’s manual if necessary.  
1. Configure TCP/IP component  
1) On the Windows taskbar, click the Start button, and then click Control Panel.  
2) Click the Network and Internet Connections icon, and then click on the Network  
Connections tab in the appearing window.  
3) Right click the icon that showed below, select Properties on the prompt page.  
Figure B-0-1  
- 269 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
4) In the prompt page that showed below, double click on the Internet Protocol (TCP/IP).  
Figure B-0-2  
5) The following TCP/IP Properties window will display and the IP Address tab is open on  
this window by default.  
- 270 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
6) Select Obtain an IP address automatically, Choose Obtain DNS server automatically, as  
shown in the Figure below:  
Figure B-0-3  
Note:  
)
For Windows 98 OS or before, the PC and Router may need to be restarted.  
7) Click OK to keep your settings.  
- 271 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Appendix C: Specifications  
General  
Standards  
Protocols  
IEEE 802.11n, 802.11b, 802.11g  
TCP/IP, PPPoE, DHCP, ICMP, NAT, SNTP  
One 10/100Mbps LAN/WAN port  
One 10/100Mbps LAN port  
Port  
10BASE-T: UTP category 3, 4, 5 cable (maximum 100m)  
EIA/TIA-568 100STP (maximum 100m)  
Cabling Type  
LED  
100BASE-TX: UTP category 5, 5e cable (maximum 100m)  
EIA/TIA-568 100STP (maximum 100m)  
SYS  
Dimensions (L×W×H) 85mm x 75mm x 28mm  
Safety & Emissions  
Wireless  
FCC, CE  
Frequency Band  
2.4~2.4835GHz  
11nup to 150MbpsAutomatic)  
11g54/48/36/24/18/12/9/6MAutomatic)  
11b11/5.5/2/1MAutomatic)  
Radio Data Rate  
Frequency Expansion DSSS(Direct Sequence Spread Spectrum)  
Modulation  
Security  
DBPSK, DQPSK, CCK, 16-QAM, 64-QAM, BPSK, QPSK  
64/128/152-bit WEP, WPA/WPA2, WPA2-PSK/WPA-PSK  
135M: -70dBm@10% PER  
65M: -73dBm@10% PER  
54M: -76dBm@10% PER  
6M: -92dBm@10% PER  
Sensitivity @PER  
Wireless Router Mode, Access Point Mode, Repeater Mode,  
Client Mode, WISP Client Router Mode  
Mode  
Environmental and Physical  
Operating :  
0~40(32~104)  
Temperature  
Storage:  
Operating:  
Storage:  
-40~70(-40~158)  
10% - 90% RH, Non-condensing  
5% - 90% RH, Non-condensing  
Humidity  
- 272 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
Appendix D: Glossary  
¾
802.11n - 802.11n builds upon previous 802.11 standards by adding MIMO (multiple-input  
multiple-output). MIMO uses multiple transmitter and receiver antennas to allow for increased  
data throughput via spatial multiplexing and increased range by exploiting the spatial diversity,  
perhaps through coding schemes like Alamouti coding. The Enhanced Wireless Consortium  
(EWC) [3] was formed to help accelerate the IEEE 802.11n development process and  
promote a technology specification for interoperability of next-generation wireless local area  
networking (WLAN) products.  
¾
¾
802.11b - The 802.11b standard specifies a wireless networking at 11 Mbps using  
direct-sequence spread-spectrum (DSSS) technology and operating in the unlicensed radio  
spectrum at 2.4GHz, and WEP encryption for security. 802.11b networks are also referred to  
as Wi-Fi networks.  
802.11g - specification for wireless networking at 54 Mbps using direct-sequence  
spread-spectrum (DSSS) technology, using OFDM modulation and operating in the  
unlicensed radio spectrum at 2.4GHz, and backward compatibility with IEEE 802.11b devices,  
and WEP encryption for security.  
¾
¾
¾
¾
DDNS (Dynamic Domain Name System) - The capability of assigning a fixed host and domain  
name to a dynamic Internet IP Address.  
DHCP (Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol) - A protocol that automatically configure the  
TCP/IP parameters for the all the PC(s) that are connected to a DHCP server.  
DMZ (Demilitarized Zone) - A Demilitarized Zone allows one local host to be exposed to the  
Internet for a special-purpose service such as Internet gaming or videoconferencing.  
DNS (Domain Name System) An Internet Service that translates the names of websites into  
IP addresses.  
¾
¾
Domain Name - A descriptive name for an address or group of addresses on the Internet.  
DSL (Digital Subscriber Line) - A technology that allows data to be sent or received over  
existing traditional phone lines.  
¾
¾
ISP (Internet Service Provider) - A company that provides access to the Internet.  
MTU (Maximum Transmission Unit) - The size in bytes of the largest packet that can be  
transmitted.  
¾
NAT (Network Address Translation) - NAT technology translates IP addresses of a local area  
network to a different IP address for the Internet.  
- 273 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TL-WR710N WiFi Pocket Router/AP/TV Adapter/Repeater  
¾
¾
PPPoE (Point to Point Protocol over Ethernet) - PPPoE is a protocol for connecting remote  
hosts to the Internet over an always-on connection by simulating a dial-up connection.  
SSID - A Service Set Identification is a thirty-two character (maximum) alphanumeric key  
identifying a wireless local area network. For the wireless devices in a network to  
communicate with each other, all devices must be configured with the same SSID. This is  
typically the configuration parameter for a wireless PC card. It corresponds to the ESSID in  
the wireless Access Point and to the wireless network name.  
¾
¾
WEP (Wired Equivalent Privacy) - A data privacy mechanism based on a 64-bit or 128-bit or  
152-bit shared key algorithm, as described in the IEEE 802.11 standard.  
Wi-Fi - A trade name for the 802.11b wireless networking standard, given by the Wireless  
Ethernet Compatibility Alliance (WECA, see http://www.wi-fi.net), an industry standards group  
promoting interoperability among 802.11b devices.  
¾
WLAN (Wireless Local Area Network) - A group of computers and associated devices  
communicate with each other wirelessly, which network serving users are limited in a local  
area.  
- 274 -  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Texas Instruments Marine Instruments bq27500 User Manual
Therma Tru Door Light Commercial Pre Hung User Manual
TOA Electronics Stereo Amplifier DA 550F CE User Manual
Tripp Lite Surge Protector TLM626SAA User Manual
Troy Bilt Tiller 630B Tuffy User Manual
U Line Ice Maker ADA24R User Manual
Verilux Indoor Furnishings VD07 User Manual
ViewSonic Computer Monitor VX922 User Manual
Viking Music Mixer MCX 106 User Manual
Wagner SprayTech Paint Sprayer Finish 250 User Manual